blob: a5255f7770e11cee5e697a09a7bde083d6128b64 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
Christopher Faulet01c10562024-09-19 17:25:44 +02006 2024/09/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -0700452.6. Size format
462.7. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Lukas Tribus5c11eb82024-01-30 21:17:44 +0000593.11. HTTPClient tuning
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020060
614. Proxies
624.1. Proxy keywords matrix
634.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
64
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100655. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200665.1. Bind options
675.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200685.3. Server DNS resolution
695.3.1. Global overview
705.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100726. Cache
736.1. Limitation
746.2. Setup
756.2.1. Cache section
766.2.2. Proxy section
77
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787. Using ACLs and fetching samples
797.1. ACL basics
807.1.1. Matching booleans
817.1.2. Matching integers
827.1.3. Matching strings
837.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
847.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
857.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
867.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
877.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200887.3.1. Converters
897.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
907.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
917.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
927.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
937.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200947.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200957.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096
978. Logging
988.1. Log levels
998.2. Log formats
1008.2.1. Default log format
1018.2.2. TCP log format
1028.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001038.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001048.2.5. Error log format
1058.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001068.3. Advanced logging options
1078.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1088.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1098.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1108.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1118.4. Timing events
1128.5. Session state at disconnection
1138.6. Non-printable characters
1148.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1158.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1168.9. Examples of logs
117
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001189. Supported filters
1199.1. Trace
1209.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001219.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001229.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001239.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001249.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001259.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200126
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012710. FastCGI applications
12810.1. Setup
12910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
13010.1.2. Proxy section
13110.1.3. Example
13210.2. Default parameters
13310.3. Limitations
134
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013511. Address formats
13611.1. Address family prefixes
13711.2. Socket type prefixes
13811.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
1401. Quick reminder about HTTP
141----------------------------
142
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100143When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
145on almost anything found in the contents.
146
147However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
148formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
149correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
150
151
1521.1. The HTTP transaction model
153-------------------------------
154
155The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100156to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100157from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
158connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159will involve a new connection :
160
161 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
162
163In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
164establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
165by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
166length.
167
168Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
169to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
170however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
171response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
172header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
173
174 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
175
176Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
177power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
178but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200179a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
183second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
184page :
185
186 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
187
188This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
189latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
190correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
191the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100192server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200194The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
195This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
196streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100197parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
198carry the stream identifier.
199
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200200
201HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200202head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200203streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
Amaury Denoyelle96c45632024-05-24 17:31:26 +0200204other streams. QUIC also provides connection migration support but currently
205haproxy does not support it.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200206
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100207By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
208connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
209leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100210start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
211processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
212waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200213
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200214HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100215 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
216 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100217 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100218 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200219 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100220
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222
2231.2. HTTP request
224-----------------
225
226First, let's consider this HTTP request :
227
228 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100229 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
231 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
232 3 User-agent: my small browser
233 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
234 5 Accept: image/png
235
236
2371.2.1. The Request line
238-----------------------
239
240Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
241
242 - a METHOD : GET
243 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
244 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
245
246All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
247which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
248followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
249is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
250desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
251the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
252
253The URI itself can have several forms :
254
255 - A "relative URI" :
256
257 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
258
259 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
260 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
261
262 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
263
264 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
265
266 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
267 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
268 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
269 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
270 must accept this form too.
271
272 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
273 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
274 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200276 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
277 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
278 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
279 other protocols too.
280
281In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
282mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
283on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
284It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
285specific to the language, framework or application in use.
286
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100287HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100288assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200290
2911.2.2. The request headers
292--------------------------
293
294The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
295beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
296an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
297Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
298values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
299encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
300the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
301define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
302
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100303Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100305"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200306as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
307normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
308representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
309HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310
311The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
312that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
313is one valid form of empty line.
314
315Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
316headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
317about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
318application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
319
320Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
323 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
324 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
325
326
3271.3. HTTP response
328------------------
329
330An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
331messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
332
333 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100334 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
336 2 Content-length: 350
337 3 Content-Type: text/html
338
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
340codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
341response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
343the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
344following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
345sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
346(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
347correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
348such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
349state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400350over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100351if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
352information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003551.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356------------------------
357
358Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
359
360 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
361 - a status code : 200
362 - a reason : OK
363
364The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
366 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
367 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
368 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
369 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000371Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100372"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
374messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
375or "Authentication Required".
376
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100377HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
379 Code When / reason
380 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
381 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
382 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
383 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100384 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
385 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 400 for an invalid or too large request
387 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
388 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100390 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100392 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
393 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400394 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200395 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400396 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100397 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200398 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200399 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200400 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
401 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
402 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
403
404The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4054.2).
406
407
4081.3.2. The response headers
409---------------------------
410
411Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
412the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
413details.
414
415
4162. Configuring HAProxy
417----------------------
418
4192.1. Configuration file format
420------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200421
422HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
423
424 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100425 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700426 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100427 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100429The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
430a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100431
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100432 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
433
434 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
435
436 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
437 tab characters
438
439 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
440 keyword sequences listed in this document
441
442 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
443 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
444 parts of the configuration, or expressions
445
446 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
447 are supported
448
449 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
450 section
451
452This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
453generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
454figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
455
456First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
457the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
458a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
459word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
460follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
461the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
462the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
463the parts that need to be addressed.
464
465A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
466requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
467extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
468the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
469section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
470section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
471not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
472
473A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
474each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
475a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
476start a new one.
477
478Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
479that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
480applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
481"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
482processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
483ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
484which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
485In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
486of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
487identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
488such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4892, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
490
491 listen foo
492 bind :80
493
494 listen bar
495 bind :81
496
497Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
498spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
499of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
500following configurations are strictly equivalent:
501
502 global#this is the global section
503 daemon#daemonize
504 frontend foo
505 mode http # or tcp
506
507and:
508
509 global
510 daemon
511
512 # this is the public web frontend
513 frontend foo
514 mode http
515
516The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
517new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
518other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
519section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
520section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
521at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
522
523Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
524are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
525editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
526support automatic indent.
527
528In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
529positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
530modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
531anymore, and is not recommended.
532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200533
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005342.2. Quoting and escaping
535-------------------------
536
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100537In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
538that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
539possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
540in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
541('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200542
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100543This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
544very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
545the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
546also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
547delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
548word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
549remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200550
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100551If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
552(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
553
554Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
555backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
557 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
558 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
559 \\ to use a backslash
560 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
561 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
562
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100563In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
564C-language representation:
565
566 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
567 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
568 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
569 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
570
571Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
572or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
573of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200576 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
577 # hash as a comment start
578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
580evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
581dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
582backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
585character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
586is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100588As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
589entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
590name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
591represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300592hence its absence there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200593
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100594 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
595 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
596 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300597 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
598 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" |
599 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
600 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" |
601 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100602 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300603 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300605 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100606 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300607 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100608 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300609 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
610 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" |
611 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100612 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300613 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200614
615 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100616 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200617 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
618 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
619 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
620 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
621 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
622
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100623There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
624necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
625by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
626they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
627escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
628characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
629case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
630if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
631own quotes.
632
633The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600634quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500635not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100636quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
637
638Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
639arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
640
641 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
643
644Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
645"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
646cannot write:
647
648 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
649
650because we would like the string to cut like this:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
653 |---------|----|-|
654 arg1 _/ / /
655 arg2 __________/ /
656 arg3 ______________/
657
658but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
659parenthesis then garbage:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
662 |--------|--------|
663 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
664 trailing garbage _________/
665
666The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
667quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
668processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
669this word:
670
671 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
672 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
673 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
674
675So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
676still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
677the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
678the second level:
679
680 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
681 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
682 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
683 |---------||----|-|
684 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
685 arg2=blah ___________/ /
686 arg3=g _______________/
687
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500688Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100689double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
690
691 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
692 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
693 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
694 |---------||----|-|
695 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
696 arg2 ___________/ /
697 arg3 _______________/
698
699When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
700appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
701string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
702thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
703
704 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
705 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
706 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
707 |-------------| |-----||-|
708 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
709 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
710 arg3 ______________________/
711
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400712Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600713that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100714quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
715single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
716level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
717
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600718Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
719if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
720or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
721
722 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
723 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
724 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
725
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100726When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
727double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600728and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100729a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
730a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
731the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
732regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
733around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
734more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200735
736
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007372.3. Environment variables
738--------------------------
739
740HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
741interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
742configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
743optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
744shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200745underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
746list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
747arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100748before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
749use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
750next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
751existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200752
753 Example:
754
755 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
756
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100757 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200758
759 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
760
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200761Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
762file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200763
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200764* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
765 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
766
767* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
768 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
769 directory.
770
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100771* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
772 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
773 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
774
775 Example:
776 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
777 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
778
779* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
780 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
781
782* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
783 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
784
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200785* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
786
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500787* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200788 processes, separated by semicolons.
789
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500790* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200791 CLI, separated by semicolons.
792
William Lallemandd4c0be62023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100793* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
794 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
795 updating the binary and reloading.
796
Sébaastien Gross2a1bcf12023-02-23 12:54:25 -0500797* HAPROXY_BRANCH: contains the HAProxy branch version (such as "2.8"). It does
798 not contain the full version number. It can be useful in case of migration
799 if resources (such as maps or certificates) are in a path containing the
800 branch number.
801
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200802In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
803regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
804only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
805
806* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
807
808* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
809 starting at one.
810
811* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
812 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
813 first section.
814
815These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
816if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
817section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
818"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
819proxies.
820
821This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
822logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
823to name some config objects like servers for example.
824
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200825See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200826
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100827
8282.4. Conditional blocks
829-----------------------
830
831It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
832some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
833ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
834configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
835versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
836preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
837text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
838lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
839switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
840are defined to form conditional blocks:
841
842 - .if <condition>
843 - .elif <condition>
844 - .else
845 - .endif
846
847The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
848as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
849matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
850there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
851only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
852".elif" of a block.
853
854Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
855ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
856as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
857
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200858Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
859See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
860
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200861The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
862expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100863
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100864 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
865 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200866 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200867 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530868 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
869 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200870 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
871 from left to right until one returns false
872 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
873 from right to left until one returns true
874
875Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
876operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200877
878The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
879
880 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
881 exists, regardless of its contents
882
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200883 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
884 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
885 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
886
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200887 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
888 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
Christopher Fauleta1fdad72023-02-20 17:55:58 +0100889 - strstr(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the second string is found in the first one
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200890
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200891 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
892 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
893 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
894 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
895
896 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
897 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
898 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
899 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
900
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100901 - enabled(<opt>) : returns true if the option <opt> is enabled at
902 run-time. Only a subset of options are supported:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +0100903 POLL, EPOLL, KQUEUE, EVPORTS, SPLICE,
904 GETADDRINFO, REUSEPORT, FAST-FORWARD,
905 SERVER-SSL-VERIFY-NONE
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100906
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200907Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100908
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200909 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
910 listen mwcli_px
911 bind :1111
912 ...
913 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100914
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200915 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
916 bind :80
917 .endif
918
919 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200920 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200921 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200922 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200923 .endif
924
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200925 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200926 bind :443 ssl crt ...
927 .endif
928
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200929 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
930 profiling.memory on
931 .endif
932
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200933 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
934 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
935 .endif
936
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200937Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100938
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200939 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100940 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
941 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
942 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
943
944Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
945"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
946fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
947provide advice to the user.
948
949Example:
950
951 .if "${A}"
952 .if "${B}"
953 .notice "A=1, B=1"
954 .elif "${C}"
955 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
956 .elif "${D}"
957 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
958 .else
959 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
960 .endif
961 .else
962 .notice "A=0"
963 .endif
964
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200965 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
966 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
967
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100968
9692.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200970----------------
971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100972Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100973values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
974otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
975numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
976for every keyword. Supported units are :
977
978 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
979 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
980 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
981 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
982 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
983 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
984
985
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -07009862.6. Size format
987----------------
988
989Some parameters involve values representing size, such as bandwidth limits.
990These values are generally expressed in bytes (unless explicitly stated
991otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
992numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
993for every keyword. Supported units are case insensitive :
994
995 - k : kilobytes. 1 kilobyte = 1024 bytes
996 - m : megabytes. 1 megabyte = 1048576 bytes
997 - g : gigabytes. 1 gigabyte = 1073741824 bytes
998
999Both time and size formats require integers, decimal notation is not allowed.
1000
1001
10022.7. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001003-------------
1004
1005 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
1006 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
1007 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
1008 global
1009 daemon
1010 maxconn 256
1011
1012 defaults
1013 mode http
1014 timeout connect 5000ms
1015 timeout client 50000ms
1016 timeout server 50000ms
1017
1018 frontend http-in
1019 bind *:80
1020 default_backend servers
1021
1022 backend servers
1023 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1024
1025
1026 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
1027 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
1028 global
1029 daemon
1030 maxconn 256
1031
1032 defaults
1033 mode http
1034 timeout connect 5000ms
1035 timeout client 50000ms
1036 timeout server 50000ms
1037
1038 listen http-in
1039 bind *:80
1040 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1041
1042
1043Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1044
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001045 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001046
1047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010483. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049--------------------
1050
1051Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1052are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1053of them have command-line equivalents.
1054
1055The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1056
1057 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001058 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001059 - 51degrees-cache-size
1060 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001061 - 51degrees-difference
1062 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001063 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1064 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001065 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1066 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001067 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001069 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001070 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001071 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001072 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001073 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - description
1075 - deviceatlas-json-file
1076 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001077 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001078 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001079 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001080 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001081 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001082 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001083 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001085 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1086 - h1-case-adjust
1087 - h1-case-adjust-file
1088 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001089 - hard-stop-after
Amaury Denoyelle1125d052024-05-22 14:21:16 +02001090 - harden.reject-privileged-ports.tcp
1091 - harden.reject-privileged-ports.quic
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001092 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001093 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001094 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001095 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001097 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001098 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001099 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001100 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001101 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001102 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001103 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001104 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001105 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001106 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001107 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001108 - presetenv
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04001109 - prealloc-fd
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001110 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001111 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001112 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001113 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001114 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001115 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02001116 - ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001117 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001118 - ssl-default-bind-options
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02001119 - ssl-default-bind-sigalgs
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001120 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001121 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001122 - ssl-default-server-options
1123 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001124 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001125 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001126 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001127 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001128 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001129 - stats
1130 - strict-limits
1131 - uid
1132 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001133 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001134 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001135 - user
1136 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001137 - wurfl-data-file
1138 - wurfl-information-list
1139 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001140
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001141 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001142 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001143 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001144 - maxcompcpuusage
1145 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001146 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001147 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001148 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001149 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001150 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001151 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001152 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001153 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001154 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001155 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001156 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001157 - nokqueue
1158 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001159 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001160 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001161 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001162 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001163 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001164 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001165 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001166 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001167 - tune.buffers.limit
1168 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001169 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001170 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01001171 - tune.disable-fast-forward
Christopher Faulet760a3842023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001172 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001173 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01001174 - tune.h2.be.glitches-threshold
Tim Duesterhus3ca274b2023-06-13 15:07:34 +02001175 - tune.h2.be.initial-window-size
1176 - tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01001177 - tune.h2.fe.glitches-threshold
Tim Duesterhus3ca274b2023-06-13 15:07:34 +02001178 - tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size
1179 - tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau4869ed52023-10-13 18:11:59 +02001180 - tune.h2.fe.max-total-streams
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001181 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001182 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001183 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Tim Duesterhusbf7493e2023-06-13 15:08:47 +02001184 - tune.h2.max-frame-size
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001185 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001186 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001187 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001188 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001189 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001190 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001191 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001192 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001193 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1194 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01001195 - tune.lua.log.loggers
1196 - tune.lua.log.stderr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001197 - tune.maxaccept
1198 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001199 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001200 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001201 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001202 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001203 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001204 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1205 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001206 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001207 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001208 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01001209 - tune.quic.max-frame-loss
Frederic Lecaillefd9424d2024-02-16 15:28:30 +01001210 - tune.quic.reorder-ratio
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001211 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001212 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001213 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1214 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001215 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001216 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001217 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001218 - tune.sndbuf.client
1219 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01001220 - tune.stick-counters
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001221 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001222 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1223 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1224 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001225 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1226 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001227 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001228 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1229 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001230 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01001231 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay
1232 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001233 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001234 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001235 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1236 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1237 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001238 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1239 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001240
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001241 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001242 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001243 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001244 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001245
Lukas Tribus5c11eb82024-01-30 21:17:44 +00001246 * HTTPClient
1247 - httpclient.resolvers.disabled
1248 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1249 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1250 - httpclient.retries
1251 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1252 - httpclient.ssl.verify
1253 - httpclient.timeout.connect
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012553.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001256------------------------------------
1257
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100125851degrees-data-file <file path>
1259 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1260 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1261
1262 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001263 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001264
126551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1266 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1267 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1268 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1269
1270 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001271 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001272
127351degrees-property-separator <char>
1274 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1275 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1276
1277 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001278 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001279
128051degrees-cache-size <number>
1281 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1282 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1283 By default, this cache is disabled.
1284
1285 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001286 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001287
128851degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1289 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1290 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1291
1292 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001293 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001294
129551degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1296 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1297 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1298
1299 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001300 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001301
130251degrees-drift <number>
1303 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1304
1305 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001306 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001307
130851degrees-difference <number>
1309 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1310
1311 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001312 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001313
131451degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1315 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1316 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1317
1318 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001319 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001320
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001321ca-base <dir>
1322 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001323 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1324 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1325 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001326
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001327chroot <jail dir>
1328 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1329 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1330 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1331 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1332 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001333 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001334
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001335close-spread-time <time>
1336 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1337 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1338 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1339 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1340 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1341 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1342 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1343 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001344 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1345 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1346 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1347 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1348 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001349
1350 Arguments :
1351 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001352 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1353 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001354
1355 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1356 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1357 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1358
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001359 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001360
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001361cluster-secret <secret>
1362 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1363 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1364 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1365 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001366 tokens.
1367
1368 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1369 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1370 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001371
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001372cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>[,...] [...]
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001373 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1374 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1375 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1376 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1377 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001378
1379 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1380
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001381 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001382 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1383 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1384 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1385 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1386 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1387 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1388 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001389 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). These
1390 CPU numbers and ranges may be repeated by delimiting them with commas or by
1391 passing more ranges as new arguments on the same line. Outside of Linux and
1392 BSD operating systems, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1393 either 31 or 63. Multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified, but each
1394 "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001395
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001396 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1397 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1398 on the machine's word size.
1399
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001400 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1401 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001402 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1403 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001404 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001405 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1406 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001407
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001408 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1409 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1410 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1411 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1412 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001413
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001414 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001415 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001416 # first 4 CPUs
1417
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001418 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1419 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001420 # word size.
1421
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001422 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001423 # and so on.
1424 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1425 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1426 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001427 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3,2,1,0
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001428
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001429 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1430 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1431 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1432 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001433
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001434 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1435 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1436 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001437
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001438 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1439 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1440 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1441 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1442 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1443
1444 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1445 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1446 # group may have more than 64 threads.
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001447 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39,80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1448 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39,80-119
1449 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79,120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1450 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79,120-159
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001451
1452
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001453crt-base <dir>
1454 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001455 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1456 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001457
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001458daemon
1459 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1460 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001461 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1462 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001463
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001464default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001465 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001466 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1467 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1468 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1469 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1470 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1471 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1472 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1473 not start with a slash ('/'):
1474 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1475 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1476
1477 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1478 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1479 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1480 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1481 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1482 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1483 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1484 each of them.
1485
1486 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1487 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1488 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1489 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1490 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1491 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1492 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1493 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1494
1495 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1496 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001497 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001498 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1499 made easily relocatable.
1500
1501 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1502 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1503 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1504 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1505 consistent across all configuration files.
1506
1507 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1508 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1509 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1510 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1511 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1512 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1513 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1514 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1515
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001516description <text>
1517 Add a text that describes the instance.
1518
1519 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1520 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1521 "<" and ">" characters.
1522
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001523deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1524 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001526
1527deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001528 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001529 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1530
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001531deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001532 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1533 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1534 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001535
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001536deviceatlas-separator <char>
1537 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1538 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1539
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001540expose-experimental-directives
1541 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1542 the config file will be rejected.
1543
Willy Tarreau39dcd1f2023-11-23 16:48:48 +01001544external-check [preserve-env]
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001545 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1546 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001547 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1548 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1549 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
Willy Tarreau39dcd1f2023-11-23 16:48:48 +01001550 By default, the checks start with a clean environment which only contains
1551 variables defined in the "external-check" command in the backend section. It
1552 may sometimes be desirable to preserve the environment though, for example
1553 when complex scripts retrieve their extra paths or information there. This
1554 can be done by appending the "preserve-env" keyword. In this case however it
1555 is strongly advised not to run a setuid nor as a privileged user, as this
1556 exposes the check program to potential attacks. See "option external-check",
1557 and "insecure-fork-wanted", and "insecure-setuid-wanted" for extra details.
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001558
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001559fd-hard-limit <number>
1560 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1561 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1562 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1563 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1564 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1565 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1566 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1567 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1568 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
Valentine Krasnobaevabff527b2024-07-03 18:45:35 +02001569 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. By default
1570 fd-hard-limit is set to 1048576. This default could be changed via
1571 DEFAULT_MAXFD compile-time variable, that could serve as the maximum (kernel)
1572 system limit, if RLIMIT_NOFILE hard limit is extremely large. fd-hard-limit
1573 set in global section allows to temporarily override the value provided via
1574 DEFAULT_MAXFD at the build-time. In the example below, no other setting is
1575 specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt to the lower of
1576 "fd-hard-limit" and the RLIMIT_NOFILE limit:
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001577
1578 global
1579 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1580 fd-hard-limit 50000
1581
1582 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1583
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001584gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001585 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001586 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1587 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001588 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001589 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001590 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001591
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001592grace <time>
1593 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1594
1595 Arguments :
1596 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1597 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1598 soft-stop operation.
1599
1600 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1601 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1602 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1603 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1604 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1605 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1606 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1607 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1608 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1609
1610 Example:
1611
1612 global
1613 grace 10s
1614
1615 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1616 frontend ext-check
1617 bind :9999
1618 monitor-uri /ext-check
1619 monitor fail if { stopping }
1620
1621 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1622 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1623 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1624 SIGUSR1 signal.
1625
1626 Example:
1627
1628 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1629 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1630 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1631 frontend ext-check
1632 bind :9999
1633 monitor-uri /ext-check
1634 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1635
1636 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1637
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001638group <group name>
1639 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1640 See also "gid" and "user".
1641
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001642h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1643 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1644
1645 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1646 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1647 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1648 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1649 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1650 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1651 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1652
1653 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1654 option may be set.
1655
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001656h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1657 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1658 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1659 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1660 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001661 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001662 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1663 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1664 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1665 specified in a proxy.
1666
1667 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1668 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1669 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1670 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1671 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1672 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1673 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1674
1675 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1676 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1677 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1678 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1679 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1680
1681 Example:
1682 global
1683 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1684
1685 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1686 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1687
1688h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1689 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1690 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1691 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1692 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1693 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1694 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1695 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1696 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1697
1698 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1699 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1700 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1701
1702 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1703 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1704
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001705h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1706 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1707 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1708 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1709 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1710 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1711 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1712 the keyword with "no'.
1713
1714hard-stop-after <time>
1715 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1716
1717 Arguments :
1718 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1719 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1720 SIGUSR1 signal.
1721
1722 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1723 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1724 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1725
1726 Example:
1727 global
1728 hard-stop-after 30s
1729
1730 See also: grace
1731
Amaury Denoyelle1125d052024-05-22 14:21:16 +02001732harden.reject-privileged-ports.tcp { on | off }
1733harden.reject-privileged-ports.quic { on | off }
1734 Toggle per protocol protection which forbid communication with clients which
1735 use privileged ports as their source port. This range of ports is defined
1736 according to RFC 6335. Protection is inactive by default on both protocols.
1737
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001738insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001739 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001740 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1741 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1742 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1743 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1744 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1745 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1746 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001747 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001748 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1749 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1750 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1751 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1752 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1753 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1754 disable it.
1755
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001756insecure-setuid-wanted
1757 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1758 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1759 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1760 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001761 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001762 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001763 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001764 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1765 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001766 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001767 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1768 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1769 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1770 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1771
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001772issuers-chain-path <dir>
1773 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1774 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1775 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001776 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001777 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1778 "issuers-chain-path".
1779 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1780 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1781 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1782 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1783 will share the chain in memory.
1784
William Lallemand61ff6132024-07-17 17:46:16 +02001785 The OCSP features are not able to use the completed chain from
1786 'issuers-chain-path', please use an additionnal .issuer file if you want to
1787 achieve OCSP stapling.
1788
Frédéric Lécailleffb67d52023-07-21 18:32:32 +02001789limited-quic
1790 This setting must be used to explicitly enable the QUIC listener bindings when
1791 haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack without QUIC support, typically
1792 OpenSSL. It has no effect when haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack
1793 with QUIC support, quictls for instance. Note that QUIC 0-RTT is not supported
1794 when this setting is set.
1795
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001796localpeer <name>
1797 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1798 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1799 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1800 the configuration parsing.
1801
1802 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1803 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1804
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001805log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001806 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001807 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001808 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001809 configured with "log global".
1810
1811 <address> can be one of:
1812
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001813 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001814 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1815 port).
1816
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001817 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1818 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1819 port).
1820
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001821 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001822 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1823 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001824 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001825
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001826 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1827 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1828 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1829 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1830 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1831 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1832 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1833 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1834 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1835 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001836 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001837 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1838 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1839 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001840 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1841 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001842
1843 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1844 "fd@2", see above.
1845
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001846 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1847 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1848 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1849 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1850 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1851
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001852 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1853 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001854
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001855 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1856 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1857 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1858 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1859 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1860 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1861 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1862 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1863 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1864 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001865 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1866 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001867
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001868 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1869 one of the following :
1870
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001871 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1872 field is stripped. This is the default.
1873 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1874 rfc3164.
1875
1876 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001877 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1878
1879 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1880 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1881
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001882 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1883 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1884 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1885 designed to be used with a local log server.
1886
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001887 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1888 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1889 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1890 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1891 logger consumes.
1892
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001893 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1894 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1895 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1896 used with a local log server.
1897
1898 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1899 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1900 designed to be used with a local log server.
1901
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001902 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1903 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1904 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1905 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1906
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001907 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1908 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1909 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1910 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1911 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1912
1913 <sample_size>
1914 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1915 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1916 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1917 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1918 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1919
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001920 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001921
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001922 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1923 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1924 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1925
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001926 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1927 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1928 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1929 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001930
1931 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001932 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1933 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1934 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1935 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1936 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1937 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001938
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001939 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001940
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001941log-send-hostname [<string>]
1942 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1943 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1944 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1945 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1946 the logs.
1947
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001948log-tag <string>
1949 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1950 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1951 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001952 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001953
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001954lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001955 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1956 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1957 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1958 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1959 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1960 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001961 used multiple times.
1962
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001963 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001964 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001965 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001966 other files.
1967
1968 local args = table.pack(...)
1969
1970lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001971 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1972 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1973 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1974 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1975 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1976 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1977 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1978 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1979 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1980 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1981 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1982 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1983 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1984 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1985 times.
1986
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001987 See lua-load for usage of args.
1988
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001989lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1990 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1991 variable.
1992 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1993 to "path".
1994
1995 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1996 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1997 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1998 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1999 will be checked earlier.
2000
2001 As an example by specifying the following path:
2002
2003 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
2004 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
2005
2006 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
2007 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
2008 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
2009 paths if that does not exist either.
2010
2011 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
2012 documentation.
2013
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002014master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002015 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
William Lallemand8c3c3932024-07-02 18:23:34 +02002016
2017 This mode will launch a "master" which will fork a "worker" after reading the
2018 configuration to process the traffic. The master is used as a process manager
2019 which will monitor the "workers".
2020
2021 Using this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal
2022 to the master. Reloading will ask the master to read the configuration again
2023 and fork a new worker. The previous worker will be kept until the end of its
2024 jobs.
2025
2026 The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground or daemon
2027 mode.
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02002028
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002029 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
2030 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
2031 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
2032 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
2033 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002034
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002035 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002036
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002037mworker-max-reloads <number>
2038 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002039 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002040 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
2041 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
2042 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
2043
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002044nbthread <number>
2045 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002046 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
2047 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
2048 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
2049 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
2050 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
2051 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
2052 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002053
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002054no-quic
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002055 Disable QUIC transport protocol. All the QUIC listeners will still be created.
2056 But they will not bind their addresses. Hence, no QUIC traffic will be
2057 processed by haproxy. See also "quic_enabled" sample fetch.
2058
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002059numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01002060 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
2061 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
2062 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
2063 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
2064 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
2065 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
2066 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
2067 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
2068 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
2069 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002070
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002071pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09002072 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
2073 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
2074 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2075 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002076
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002077pp2-never-send-local
2078 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2079 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2080 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2081 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2082 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2083 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2084 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2085 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2086 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2087 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2088 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2089
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002090presetenv <name> <value>
2091 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2092 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2093 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2094 and "unsetenv".
2095
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04002096prealloc-fd
2097 Performs a one-time open of the maximum file descriptor which results in a
2098 pre-allocation of the kernel's data structures. This prevents short pauses
2099 when nbthread>1 and HAProxy opens a file descriptor which requires the kernel
2100 to expand its data structures.
2101
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002102resetenv [<name> ...]
2103 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2104 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2105 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2106 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2107 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2108 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2109 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2110 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2111
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002112server-state-base <directory>
2113 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002114 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2115 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002116
2117server-state-file <file>
2118 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2119 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2120 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2121 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2122 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2123 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2124 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2125 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002126 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2127 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002128
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002129set-dumpable
2130 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2131 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2132 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2133 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2134 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2135 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2136 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2137 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2138 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2139 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2140 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2141 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2142 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2143 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2144 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2145 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2146 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2147 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2148
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002149set-var <var-name> <expr>
2150 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2151 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2152 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2153 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2154 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2155 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002156 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002157 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2158 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2159
2160 Example:
2161 global
2162 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2163 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2164 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2165
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002166set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2167 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2168 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2169 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2170 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2171 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2172 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2173 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2174 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2175 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02002176 Please see section 8.2.6 for details on the custom log-format syntax.
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002177
2178 Example:
2179 global
2180 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2181 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2182
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02002183setcap <name>[,<name>...]
2184 Sets a list of capabilities that must be preserved when starting with uid 0
2185 and switching to a non-zero uid. By default all permissions are lost by the
2186 uid switch, but some are often needed when trying connecting to a server from
2187 a foreign address during transparent proxying, or when binding to a port
2188 below 1024, e.g. when using "tune.quic.socket-owner connection", resulting in
2189 setups running entirely under uid 0. Setting capabilities generally is a
2190 safer alternative, as only the required capabilities will be preserved. The
2191 feature is OS-specific and only enabled on Linux when USE_LINUX_CAP=1 is set
2192 at build time. The list of supported capabilities also depends on the OS and
2193 is enumerated by the error message displayed when an invalid capability name
2194 or an empty one is passed. Multiple capabilities may be passed, delimited by
2195 commas. Among those commonly used, "cap_net_raw" allows to transparently bind
2196 to a foreign address, and "cap_net_bind_service" allows to bind to a
2197 privileged port and may be used by QUIC.
2198
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002199setenv <name> <value>
2200 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2201 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2202 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2203 and "unsetenv".
2204
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002205ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2206 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2207 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002208 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002209 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002210 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2211 information and recommendations see e.g.
2212 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2213 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2214 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2215 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002216
2217ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2218 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2219 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +01002220 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2221 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2222 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
2223 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2224 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2225 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. This setting might accept TLSv1.2
2226 ciphersuites however this is an undocumented behavior and not recommended as
2227 it could be inconsistent or buggy.
2228 The default TLSv1.3 ciphersuites of OpenSSL are:
2229 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
2230
2231 TLSv1.3 only supports 5 ciphersuites:
2232
2233 - TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
2234 - TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
2235 - TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256
2236 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_SHA256
2237 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_8_SHA256
2238
2239 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2240
2241 Example:
2242 global
2243 ssl-default-bind-ciphers ECDHE-RSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384:ECDHE-RSA-CHACHA20-POLY1305:ECDHE-RSA-AES128-GCM-SHA256
2244 ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002245
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02002246ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2248 the default string describing the list of signature algorithms related to
2249 client authentication for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2250 theirs. The format of the string is a colon-delimited list of signature
2251 algorithms. Each signature algorithm can use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature
2252 scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256") or the public key algorithm + digest form
2253 ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list can contain both forms. For more information on the
2254 format, see SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is
2255 also available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c
2256 file. This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2257 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2258 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2259 with a middlebox is required.
2260
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002261ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2262 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2263 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2264 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2265 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2266 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2267
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002268ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2269 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2270 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2271 keyword to see available options.
2272
2273 Example:
2274 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002275 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002276
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02002277ssl-default-bind-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2279 sets the default string describing the list of signature algorithms that
2280 are negotiated during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines
2281 which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is a
2282 colon-delimited list of signature algorithms. Each signature algorithm can
2283 use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256")
2284 or the public key algorithm + digest form ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list
2285 can contain both forms. For more information on the format,
2286 see SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is also
2287 available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c file.
2288 This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2289 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2290 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2291 with a middlebox is required.
2292
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002293ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2295 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002296 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002297 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002298 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2299 information and recommendations see e.g.
2300 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2301 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2302 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2303 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2304 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002305
2306ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +01002308 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2309 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2310 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2311 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002312 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +01002313 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2314 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2315 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002316
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002317ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2319 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2320 keyword to see available options.
2321
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002322ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2323 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2324 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2325 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002326 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002327 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002328 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002329 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2330 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2331 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2332 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002333 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2334 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2335 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2336
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002337ssl-propquery <query>
2338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2339 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2340 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2341 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2342 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2343 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2344 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2345 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2346 was not found.
2347
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002348ssl-provider <name>
2349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2350 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2351 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2352 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2353 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2354 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002355
2356 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002357 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2358 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2359 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2360 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2361 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002362
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002363 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2364 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2365 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2366 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002367
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002368 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2369
2370ssl-provider-path <path>
2371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2372 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2373 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2374 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2375 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2376 defined.
2377 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002378
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002379ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2380 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2381 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002382 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002383 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002384 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2385
2386 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002387
2388 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2389 and won't try to remove them.
2390
2391 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2392
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002393ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002394 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002395 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2396 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2397 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002398
2399 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2400 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2401 optimize the startup time.
2402
2403 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2404 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2405 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2406
2407 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002408 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002409
2410 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002411 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2412 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002413
2414 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2415 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2416 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2417 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2418 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002419 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002420
2421 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002422 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002423 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2424 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2425 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2426 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2427 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002428 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002429
2430 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2431
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002432 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002433 a cert bundle.
2434
2435 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2436 separately in several "crt".
2437
2438 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2439 since files are loading separately.
2440
2441 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2442 required to commit them.
2443
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002444 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002445 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002446
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002447 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2448 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2449 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002450
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002451 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2452 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2453 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002454
2455 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002456 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2457 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002458
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002459 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2460 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2461
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002462 The default behavior is "all".
2463
2464 Example:
2465 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2466 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2467 ssl-load-extra-files none
2468
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002469 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2470 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002471
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002472ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2473 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2474 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2475 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2476
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002477ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002478 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002479 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2480 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2481 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2482 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2483 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2484 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002485 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002486
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002487stats maxconn <connections>
2488 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2489 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2490
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002491stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2492 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2493 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2494 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002495 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002496 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002497
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002498 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2499 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2500 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002501
2502stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2503 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2504 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002505 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002506
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002507strict-limits
2508 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2509 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2510 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2511 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2512 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002513
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002514thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2515 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2516 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2517 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2518 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2519 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2520 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2521 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2522 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2523 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2524
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002525thread-groups <number>
2526 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2527 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002528 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2529 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2530 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2531 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2532 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002533
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002534trace <args...>
2535 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2536 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2537 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2538 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2539 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2540 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2541 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2542 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2543 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2544 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2545 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2546 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2547 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2548 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2549 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2550 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2551 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2552
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002553uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002554 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002555 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2556 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2557 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2558
2559ulimit-n <number>
2560 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2561 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002562 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2563 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002564
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002565 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2566 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2567 manually specify this value.
2568
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002569 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2570
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002571unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2572 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2573
2574 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2575 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2576 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2577 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2578 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002579 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002580 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2581 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2582 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2583 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2584
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002585unsetenv [<name> ...]
2586 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2587 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2588 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2589 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2590 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2591 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2592 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2593
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002594user <user name>
2595 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2596 See also "uid" and "group".
2597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002598node <name>
2599 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2600
2601 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2602 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2603 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2604 traffic.
2605
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002606wurfl-cache-size <size>
2607 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2608 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2609 - "0" : no cache is used.
2610 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002611
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002612 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2613 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002614
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002615wurfl-data-file <file path>
2616 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2617 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2618
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002619 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002620 with USE_WURFL=1.
2621
2622wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2623 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2624 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2625 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2626
2627 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2628
2629 Valid WURFL properties are:
2630 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2631
2632 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2633 device.
2634
2635 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2636 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2637
2638 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2639 particular web request.
2640
2641 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2642 used Libwurfl API version.
2643
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002644 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2645 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2646
2647 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2648 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2649
2650 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2651
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002652 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002653 with USE_WURFL=1.
2654
2655wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2656 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2657 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2658
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002659 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002660 with USE_WURFL=1.
2661
2662wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2663 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2664 thus before the chroot.
2665
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002666 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002667 with USE_WURFL=1.
2668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026693.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002670-----------------------
2671
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002672busy-polling
2673 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2674 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2675 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2676 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2677 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2678 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2679 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2680 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2681 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2682 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2683 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2684 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2685 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2686 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2687 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2688 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2689 "poll" pollers.
2690
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002691 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2692 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2693 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2694
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002695max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002696 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002697 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2698 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2699 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2700 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2701 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2702 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2703 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2704
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002705maxcompcpuusage <number>
2706 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2707 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2708 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2709 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2710 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2711 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2712 and from introducing high latencies.
2713
2714maxcomprate <number>
2715 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2716 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2717 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2718 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2719 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2720 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2721 default value.
2722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002723maxconn <number>
2724 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
Valentine Krasnobaeva3fcfb832024-07-03 16:03:33 +02002725 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". The value provided in
2726 command-line argument via "-n" takes the precedence over the maxconn value set
2727 in the global section. Haproxy process could be also compiled with
2728 SYSTEM_MAXCONN compile-time variable, which is served in this case as the
2729 system maxconn maximum. Again, the command-line "-n" argument allows at
2730 runtime to bypass SYSTEM_MAXCONN limit, if set. Proxies will stop accepting
2731 connections when maxconn is reached. The process soft file descriptor limit
2732 (could be obtained with "ulimit -n" command) is automatically adjusted
2733 according to provided maxconn. See also "ulimit-n". Note: the "select" poller
2734 cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on some platforms. If your
2735 platform only supports select and reports "select FAILED" on startup, you need
2736 to reduce the maxconn until it works (slightly below 500 in general). If
2737 maxconn value is not set, it will be automatically calculated based on the
2738 current file descriptors limits, reported by the "ulimit -nH" command (we take
2739 the maximum between the hard and soft values), then automatic value will be
2740 possibly reduced by "fd-hard-limit" and by memory limit, if the latter was
2741 enforced via "-m" command line option. Automatic value is also dependent from
2742 the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and the use
2743 or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002744
2745 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002746
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002747maxconnrate <number>
2748 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2749 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2750 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2751 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2752 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2753 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2754 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2755 fairness.
2756
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002757maxpipes <number>
2758 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2759 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2760 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2761 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2762 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2763 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2764
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002765maxsessrate <number>
2766 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2767 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2768 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2769 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2770 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2771 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2772 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2773 fairness.
2774
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002775maxsslconn <number>
2776 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2777 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2778 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2779 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2780 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2781 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2782 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002783 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2784 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2785 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2786 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002787 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002788 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2789 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002790
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002791maxsslrate <number>
2792 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2793 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2794 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2795 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2796 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2797 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2798 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2799 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2800 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2801 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2802
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002803maxzlibmem <number>
2804 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2805 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2806 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002807 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2808 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2809 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2810
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002811no-memory-trimming
2812 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2813 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2814 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2815 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2816 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2817 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2818 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2819 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2820 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2821 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2822 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2823 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2824 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2825 not suffer from such a problem.
2826
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002827noepoll
2828 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2829 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002830 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002831
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002832noevports
2833 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2834 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2835 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2836 also "nopoll".
2837
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002838nogetaddrinfo
2839 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2840 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2841
2842nokqueue
2843 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2844 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2845 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002847nopoll
2848 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2849 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002850 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002851 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2852 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002853
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002854noreuseport
2855 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2856 command line argument "-dR".
2857
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002858nosplice
2859 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002860 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002861 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002862 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002863 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2864 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2865 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2866 "option splice-response".
2867
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002868profiling.memory { on | off }
2869 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2870 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2871 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2872 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2873 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2874 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2875 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2876 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2877 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2878
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002879profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2880 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2881 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2882 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2883 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002884 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002885 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2886 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2887 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2888 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2889
2890 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2891 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2892 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2893 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2894 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002895 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2896 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2897 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2898 CLI.
2899
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002900spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002901 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2902 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2903 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2904 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2905 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2906 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002907
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002908ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002909 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002910 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002911 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002912 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002913 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2914 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2915 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002916 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2917 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002918 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2919 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2920 openssl configuration file uses:
2921 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2922
Aleksandar Lazic89fb2102022-07-27 15:24:54 +02002923 HAProxy Version 2.6 disabled the support for engines in the default build.
2924 This option is only available when HAProxy has been built with support for
2925 it. In case the ssl-engine is required HAProxy can be rebuild with the
2926 USE_ENGINE=1 flag.
2927
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002928ssl-mode-async
2929 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002930 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002931 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2932 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002933 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002934 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002935 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002936
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002937tune.buffers.limit <number>
2938 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2939 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2940 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2941 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2942 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002943 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002944 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2945 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2946 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2947 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2948 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2949 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2950 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2951 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002952 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002953
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002954tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2955 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2956 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2957 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002958 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002959
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002960tune.bufsize <number>
2961 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2962 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2963 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2964 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2965 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2966 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2967 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002968 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2969 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002970 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002971 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002972 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002973 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2974 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002975
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002976tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2977 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2978 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2979 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2980 this value. The default value is 1.
2981
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01002982tune.disable-fast-forward [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2983 Disables the data fast-forwarding. It is a mechanism to optimize the data
2984 forwarding by passing data directly from a side to the other one without
2985 waking the stream up. Thanks to this directive, it is possible to disable
2986 this optimization. Note it also disable any kernel tcp splicing. This command
2987 is not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by
2988 developers along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally
2989 marked as experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must
2990 appear on a line before this directive.
2991
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002992tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002993 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2994 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2995 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
Willy Tarreau0c4348c2023-03-21 09:24:53 +01002996 failures are handled gracefully. When not set, the ratio is 0. However the
2997 command-line "-dMfail" option automatically sets it to 1% failure rate so that
2998 it is not necessary to change the configuration for testing.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002999
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02003000tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
3001 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
3002 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
3003 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
3004 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
3005 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
3006
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01003007tune.h2.be.glitches-threshold <number>
3008 Sets the threshold for the number of glitches on a backend connection, where
3009 that connection will automatically be killed. This allows to automatically
3010 kill misbehaving connections without having to write explicit rules for them.
3011 The default value is zero, indicating that no threshold is set so that no
3012 event will cause a connection to be closed. Beware that some H2 servers may
3013 occasionally cause a few glitches over long lasting connection, so any non-
3014 zero value here should probably be in the hundreds or thousands to be
3015 effective without affecting slightly bogus servers.
3016
3017 See also: tune.h2.fe.glitches-threshold, bc_glitches
3018
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003019tune.h2.be.initial-window-size <number>
3020 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for outgoing connections, which is the
3021 number of bytes the server can respond before waiting for an acknowledgment
3022 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents, not headers. When
3023 not set, the common default value set by tune.h2.initial-window-size applies.
3024 It can make sense to slightly increase this value to allow faster downloads
3025 or to reduce CPU usage on the servers, at the expense of creating unfairness
3026 between clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02003027
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003028 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
3029
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003030tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams <number>
3031 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per outgoing connection
3032 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection to a server).
3033 When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams applies. A
3034 smaller value than the default 100 may improve a site's responsiveness at the
3035 expense of maintaining more established connections to the servers. When the
3036 "http-reuse" setting is set to "always", it is recommended to reduce this
3037 value so as not to mix too many different clients over the same connection,
3038 because if a client is slower than others, a mechanism known as "head of
3039 line blocking" tends to cause cascade effect on download speed for all
3040 clients sharing a connection (keep tune.h2.be.initial-window-size low in this
3041 case). It is highly recommended not to increase this value; some might find
3042 it optimal to run at low values (1..5 typically).
3043
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01003044tune.h2.fe.glitches-threshold <number>
3045 Sets the threshold for the number of glitches on a frontend connection, where
3046 that connection will automatically be killed. This allows to automatically
3047 kill misbehaving connections without having to write explicit rules for them.
3048 The default value is zero, indicating that no threshold is set so that no
3049 event will cause a connection to be closed. Beware that some H2 clientss may
3050 occasionally cause a few glitches over long lasting connection, so any non-
3051 zero value here should probably be in the hundreds or thousands to be
3052 effective without affecting slightly bogus clients.
3053
3054 See also: tune.h2.be.glitches-threshold, fc_glitches
3055
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003056tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size <number>
3057 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for incoming connections, which is the
3058 number of bytes the client can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment
3059 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of
3060 POST requests), not headers. When not set, the common default value set by
3061 tune.h2.initial-window-size applies. It can make sense to increase this value
3062 to allow faster uploads. The default value of 65536 allows up to 5 Mbps of
3063 bandwidth per client over a 100 ms ping time, and 500 Mbps for 1 ms ping
3064 time. It doesn't affect resource usage. Using too large values may cause
3065 clients to experience a lack of responsiveness if pages are accessed in
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02003066 parallel to large uploads.
3067
3068 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003069
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003070tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams <number>
3071 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per incoming connection
3072 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection from a
3073 client). When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
3074 applies. A larger value than the default 100 may sometimes slightly improve
3075 the page load time for complex sites with lots of small objects over high
3076 latency networks but can also result in using more memory by allowing a
3077 client to allocate more resources at once. The default value of 100 is
3078 generally good and it is recommended not to change this value.
3079
Willy Tarreau4869ed52023-10-13 18:11:59 +02003080tune.h2.fe.max-total-streams <number>
3081 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of total streams processed per incoming
3082 connection. Once this limit is reached, HAProxy will send a graceful GOAWAY
3083 frame informing the client that it will close the connection after all
3084 pending streams have been closed. In practice, clients tend to close as fast
3085 as possible when receiving this, and to establish a new connection for next
3086 requests. Doing this is sometimes useful and desired in situations where
3087 clients stay connected for a very long time and cause some imbalance inside a
3088 farm. For example, in some highly dynamic environments, it is possible that
3089 new load balancers are instantiated on the fly to adapt to a load increase,
3090 and that once the load goes down they should be stopped without breaking
3091 established connections. By setting a limit here, the connections will have
3092 a limited lifetime and will be frequently renewed, with some possibly being
3093 established to other nodes, so that existing resources are quickly released.
3094
3095 It's important to understand that there is an implicit relation between this
3096 limit and "tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams" above. Indeed, HAProxy will
3097 always accept to process any possibly pending streams that might be in flight
3098 between the client and the frontend, so the advertised limit will always
3099 automatically be raised by the value configured in max-concurrent-streams,
3100 and this value will serve as a hard limit above which a violation by a non-
3101 compliant client will result in the connection being closed. Thus when
3102 counting the number of requests per connection from the logs, any number
3103 between max-total-streams and (max-total-streams + max-concurrent-streams)
3104 may be observed depending on how fast streams are created by the client.
3105
3106 The default value is zero, which enforces no limit beyond those implied by
3107 the protocol (2^30 ~= 1.07 billion). Values around 1000 may already cause
3108 frequent connection renewal without causing any perceptible latency to most
3109 clients. Setting it too low may result in an increase of CPU usage due to
3110 frequent TLS reconnections, in addition to increased page load time. Please
3111 note that some load testing tools do not support reconnections and may report
3112 errors with this setting; as such it may be needed to disable it when running
3113 performance benchmarks. See also "tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams".
3114
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02003115tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
3116 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
3117 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
3118 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
3119 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
3120 change it.
3121
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003122tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003123 Sets the default value for the HTTP/2 initial window size, on both incoming
3124 and outgoing connections. This value is used for incoming connections when
3125 tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size is not set, and by outgoing connections when
3126 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size is not set. The default value is 65536, which
3127 for uploads roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of bandwidth per client over a
3128 network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps over a 1-ms local network.
3129 Given that changing the default value will both increase upload speeds and
3130 cause more unfairness between clients on downloads, it is recommended to
3131 instead use the side-specific settings tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size and
3132 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003133
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003134tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003135 Sets the default HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003136 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection). This value
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003137 is used for incoming connections when tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams is
3138 not set, and for outgoing connections when tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
3139 is not set. The default value is 100. The impact varies depending on the side
3140 so please see the two settings above for more details. It is recommended not
3141 to use this setting and to switch to the per-side ones instead. A value of
3142 zero disables the limit so a single client may create as many streams as
3143 allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003144
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003145tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003146 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003147 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003148 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003149 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
3150 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
3151 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
3152 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
3153
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003154tune.http.cookielen <number>
3155 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
3156 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
3157 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
3158 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
3159 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
3160 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
3161 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
3162 to change this value.
3163
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003164tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003165 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
3166 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003167 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003168 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003169 configuration directives too.
3170 The default value is 1024.
3171
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003172tune.http.maxhdr <number>
3173 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
3174 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
3175 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
3176 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
3177 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
3178 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02003179 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
3180 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
3181 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003182
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003183tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
3184 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
3185 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
3186 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
3187 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
3188 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
3189 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01003190 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
3191 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
3192 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
3193 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
3194 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003195
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003196tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003197 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003198 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
3199 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
3200 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
3201 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003202 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003203 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003204 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003205 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
3206
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003207tune.listener.default-shards { by-process | by-thread | by-group }
3208 Normally, all "bind" lines will create a single shard, that is, a single
3209 socket that all threads of the process will listen to. With many threads,
3210 this is not very efficient, and may even induce some important overhead in
3211 the kernel for updating the polling state or even distributing events to the
3212 various threads. Modern operating systems support balancing of incoming
3213 connections, a mechanism that will consist in permitting multiple sockets to
3214 be bound to the same address and port, and to evenly distribute all incoming
3215 connections to these sockets so that each thread only sees the connections
3216 that are waiting in the socket it is bound to. This significantly reduces
3217 kernel-side overhead and increases performance in the incoming connection
3218 path. This is usually enabled in HAProxy using the "shards" setting on "bind"
3219 lines, which defaults to 1, meaning that each listener will be unique in the
3220 process. On systems with many processors, it may be more convenient to change
3221 the default setting to "by-thread" in order to always create one listening
3222 socket per thread, or "by-group" in order to always create one listening
3223 socket per thread group. Be careful about the file descriptor usage with
3224 "by-thread" as each listener will need as many sockets as there are threads.
3225 Also some operating systems (e.g. FreeBSD) are limited to no more than 256
3226 sockets on a same address. Note that "by-group" will remain equivalent to
3227 "by-process" for default configurations involving a single thread group, and
3228 will fall back to sharing the same socket on systems that do not support this
Willy Tarreau0e875cf2023-04-23 00:51:59 +02003229 mechanism. The default is "by-group" with a fallback to "by-process" for
3230 systems or socket families that do not support multiple bindings.
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003231
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003232tune.listener.multi-queue { on | fair | off }
3233 Enables ('on' / 'fair') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept
3234 which spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to
3235 run on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003236 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
3237 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003238 with one thread for example). The default mode, "on", optimizes the choice of
3239 a thread by picking in a sample the one with the less connections. It is
3240 often the best choice when connections are long-lived as it manages to keep
3241 all threads busy. A second mode, "fair", instead cycles through all threads
3242 regardless of their instant load level. It can be better suited for short-
3243 lived connections, or on machines with very large numbers of threads where
3244 the probability to find the least loaded thread with the first mode is low.
3245 Finally it is possible to forcefully disable the redistribution mechanism
3246 using "off" for troubleshooting, or for situations where connections are
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003247 short-lived and it is estimated that the operating system already provides a
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003248 good enough distribution. The default is "on".
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003249
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003250tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
3251 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003252 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003253 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
3254 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003255 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003256 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
3257 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
3258
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01003259tune.lua.maxmem
3260 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
3261 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
3262 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
3263 memory.
3264
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003265tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
3266 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003267 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3268 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003269 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003270
Aurelien DARRAGON58e36e52023-04-06 22:51:56 +02003271tune.lua.burst-timeout <timeout>
3272 The "burst" execution timeout applies to any Lua handler. If the handler
3273 fails to finish or yield before timeout is reached, it will be aborted to
3274 prevent thread contention, to prevent traffic from not being served for too
3275 long, and ultimately to prevent the process from crashing because of the
3276 watchdog kicking in. Unlike other lua timeouts which are yield-cumulative,
3277 burst-timeout will ensure that the time spent in a single lua execution
3278 window does not exceed the configured timeout.
3279
3280 Yielding here means that the lua execution is effectively interrupted
3281 either through an explicit call to lua-yielding function such as
3282 core.(m)sleep() or core.yield(), or following an automatic forced-yield
3283 (see tune.lua.forced-yield) and that it will be resumed later when the
3284 related task is set for rescheduling. Not all lua handlers may yield: we have
3285 to make a distinction between yieldable handlers and unyieldable handlers.
3286
3287 For yieldable handlers (tasks, actions..), reaching the timeout means
3288 "tune.lua.forced-yield" might be too high for the system, reducing it
3289 could improve the situation, but it could also be a good idea to check if
3290 adding manual yields at some key points within the lua function helps or not.
3291 It may also indicate that the handler is spending too much time in a specific
3292 lua library function that cannot be interrupted.
3293
3294 For unyieldable handlers (lua converters, sample fetches), it could simply
3295 indicate that the handler is doing too much computation, which could result
3296 from an improper design given that such handlers, which often block the
3297 request execution flow, are expected to terminate quickly to allow the
3298 request processing to go through. A common resolution approach here would be
3299 to try to better optimize the lua function for speed since decreasing
3300 "tune.lua.forced-yield" won't help.
3301
3302 This timeout only counts the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a core.sleep,
3303 the sleeping time is not taken in account. The default timeout is 1000ms.
3304
3305 Note: if a lua GC cycle is initiated from the handler (either explicitly
3306 requested or automatically triggered by lua after some time), the GC cycle
3307 time will also be accounted for.
3308
3309 Indeed, there is no way to deduce the GC cycle time, so this could lead to
3310 some false positives on saturated systems (where GC is having hard time to
3311 catch up and consumes most of the available execution runtime). If it were
3312 to be the case, here are some resolution leads:
3313
3314 - checking if the script could be optimized to reduce lua memory footprint
3315 - fine-tuning lua GC parameters and / or requesting manual GC cycles
3316 (see: https://www.lua.org/manual/5.4/manual.html#pdf-collectgarbage)
3317 - increasing tune.lua.burst-timeout
3318
3319 Setting value to 0 completely disables this protection.
3320
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003321tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
3322 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
3323 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3324 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003325 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003326
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003327tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
3328 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
3329 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
3330 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
3331 check servers.
3332
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01003333tune.lua.log.loggers { on | off }
3334 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via the
3335 loggers applicable to the current proxy, if any.
3336
3337 Defaults to 'on'.
3338
3339tune.lua.log.stderr { on | auto | off }
3340 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via
3341 stderr.
3342 When set to 'auto', logging via stderr is conditionally 'on' if any of:
3343
3344 - tune.lua.log.loggers is set to 'off'
3345 - the script is executed in a non-proxy context with no global logger
3346 - the script is executed in a proxy context with no logger attached
3347
3348 Please note that, when enabled, this logging is in addition to the logging
3349 configured via tune.lua.log.loggers.
3350
3351 Defaults to 'on'.
3352
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003353tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01003354 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
3355 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01003356 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
3357 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
3358 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
3359 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
3360 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
3361 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
3362 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
3363 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
3364 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003365
3366tune.maxpollevents <number>
3367 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
3368 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
3369 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
3370 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
3371 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
3372
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02003373tune.maxrewrite <number>
3374 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
3375 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
3376 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
3377 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
3378 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
3379 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
3380 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
3381 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
3382 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
3383 bufsize.
3384
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003385tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3386 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3387 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3388 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3389 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3390 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3391 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3392 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3393 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3394 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3395 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3396 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3397 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3398 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3399 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3400
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003401tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3402 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3403 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3404 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3405 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3406 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3407 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3408 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3409 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3410 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003411 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3412 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003413 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3414 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3415 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3416 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3417 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3418 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3419 setting this parameter to 0.
3420
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003421tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3422 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3423 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3424 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3425 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3426 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3427 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3428 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3429
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003430tune.pipesize <number>
3431 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3432 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3433 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3434 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3435 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3436 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3437
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003438tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3439 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003440 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003441 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3442 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3443 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3444 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003445 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003446
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003447tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3448 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003449 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003450 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3451 default is 20.
3452
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003453tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003454 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3455 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3456 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3457 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003458 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003459
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003460tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003461 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3462 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3463 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3464 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3465 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3466 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3467 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3468
3469 The default value is 30000.
3470
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003471tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003472 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3473 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3474 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3475 requests.
3476
3477 The default value is 100.
3478
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003479tune.quic.max-frame-loss <number>
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003480 Sets the limit for which a single QUIC frame can be marked as lost. If
3481 exceeded, the connection is considered as failing and is closed immediately.
3482
3483 The default value is 10.
3484
Frederic Lecaillef1724f42024-02-13 19:38:46 +01003485tune.quic.reorder-ratio <0..100, in percent>
3486 The ratio applied to the packet reordering threshold calculated. It may
3487 trigger a high packet loss detection when too small.
3488
3489 The default value is 50.
3490
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003491tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003492 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003493 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3494 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003495 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3496 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003497 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3498 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003499
3500 The default value is 100.
3501
3502 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3503 information about QUIC retry.
3504
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003505tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003506 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3507 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3508 own socket.
3509
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003510 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3511 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003512 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. This is also the only way to
Amaury Denoyellee1a0ee32023-02-28 15:11:09 +01003513 ensure soft-stop is conducted properly without data loss for QUIC connections
3514 and cases of transient errors during sendto() operation are handled
3515 efficiently. However, this relies on some advanced features from the UDP
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003516 network stack. If your platform is deemed not compatible, haproxy will
Willy Tarreau2a3d9282023-08-29 10:22:46 +02003517 automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup. Please note that QUIC
3518 listeners running on privileged ports may require to run as uid 0, or some
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02003519 OS-specific tuning to permit the target uid to bind such ports, such as
3520 system capabilities. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003521
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003522 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3523 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3524 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003525 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003526 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003527
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003528tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3529tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3530 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3531 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3532 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003533 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003534 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003535 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3536 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3537
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003538tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003539 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003540 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3541 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3542 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3543 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3544
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003545tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003546 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003547 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3548 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3549 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3550 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3551 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3552 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3553 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003554
3555tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3556 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003557 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003558 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3559 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3560 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3561 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3562 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3563 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3564 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003565
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003566tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3567tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3568 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3569 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3570 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003571 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003572 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003573 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3574 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3575 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3576 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003577 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003578
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003579tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003580 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003581 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3582 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3583 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3584 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3585 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3586 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3587 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3588 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3589 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003590 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3591 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003592
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003593tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3594tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3595 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3596 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3597 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3598 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3599
3600tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3601 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3602 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3603 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3604 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3605 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3606 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3607 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3608 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3609 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3610 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3611 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3612 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3613
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003614tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003615 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003616 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3617 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3618 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3619 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3620 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3621
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003622tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3623 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3624 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3625 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3626 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3627
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003628tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3629 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3630 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3631 performances. This is disabled by default.
3632
3633 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3634 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3635
3636 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3637
3638 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3639
3640 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3641
3642 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3643 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3644 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3645
3646 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3647 converted.
3648
3649 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3650 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3651 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3652 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3653 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3654 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3655 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003656 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3657 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003658
3659 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3660
3661 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3662 only need this line:
3663
3664 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3665
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003666tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3667 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003668 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003669 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3670 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3671 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3672 being used for too long.
3673
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003674tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003675 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3676 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3677 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3678 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3679 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3680 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3681 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3682 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3683 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3684 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3685 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3686 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3687 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003688
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003689tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3690 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3691 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3692 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3693 1000 entries.
3694
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01003695tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay <number>
3696 Sets the maximum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3697 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 3600 (1 hour). It
3698 must be set to a higher value than "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay". See
3699 option "ocsp-update" for more information about the auto update mechanism.
3700
3701tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay <number>
3702 Sets the minimum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3703 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 minutes).
3704 It is particularly useful for OCSP response that do not have explicit
3705 expiration times. It must be set to a lower value than
3706 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay". See option "ocsp-update" for more
3707 information about the auto update mechanism.
3708
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003709tune.stick-counters <number>
3710 Sets the number of stick-counters that may be tracked at the same time by a
3711 connection or a request via "track-sc*" actions in "tcp-request" or
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02003712 "http-request" rules. The default value is set at build time by the macro
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003713 MAX_SESS_STK_CTR, and defaults to 3. With this setting it is possible to
3714 change the value and ignore the one passed at build time. Increasing this
3715 value may be needed when porting complex configurations to haproxy, but users
3716 are warned against the costs: each entry takes 16 bytes per connection and
3717 16 bytes per request, all of which need to be allocated and zeroed for all
3718 requests even when not used. As such a value of 10 will inflate the memory
3719 consumption per request by 320 bytes and will cause this memory to be erased
3720 for each request, which does have measurable CPU impacts. Conversely, when
3721 no "track-sc" rules are used, the value may be lowered (0 being valid to
3722 entirely disable stick-counters).
3723
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003724tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003725tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003726tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3727tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3728tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003729 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3730 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3731 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3732 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3733 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3734 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3735 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3736 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003737
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003738 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3739 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3740 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3741 all available space is consumed.
3742 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3743 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3744 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003745
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003746tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3747 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003748 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003749 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003750 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003751 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3752
3753tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3754 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3755 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003756 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3757 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037593.3. Debugging
3760--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003761
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003762anonkey <key>
3763 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3764 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3765 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Amaury Denoyelledd3a33f2023-03-03 17:11:10 +01003766 from the CLI command "set anon global-key". See also command line argument
3767 "-dC" in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003768
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003769quick-exit
3770 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3771 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3772 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3773 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3774 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3775 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3776 do so by developers.
3777
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003778quiet
3779 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3780 line argument "-q".
3781
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003782zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003783 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003784 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3785 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3786 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3787 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3788 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3789
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010037913.4. Userlists
3792--------------
3793It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3794http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3795it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3796
3797userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003798 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003799 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3800
3801group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003802 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003803 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3804 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3805
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003806user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3807 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003808 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3809 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003810 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3811 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3812 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3813 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003814
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003815 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3816 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3817 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3818 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3819 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3820 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3821 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003822 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003823 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003824
3825 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003826 userlist L1
3827 group G1 users tiger,scott
3828 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003829
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003830 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3831 user scott insecure-password elgato
3832 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003833
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003834 userlist L2
3835 group G1
3836 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003837
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003838 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3839 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3840 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003841
3842 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003843
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003844
38453.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003846----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003847It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003848several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003849instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003850values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3851type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3852values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3853active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3854switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3855present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3856watch it.
3857
3858Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3859known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3860the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3861process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3862during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3863tables.
3864
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003865Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3866that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3867each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003868
3869peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003870 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003871 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3872
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003873bind [<address>]:port [param*]
3874bind /<path> [param*]
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003875 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3876 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3877
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003878disabled
3879 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3880 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3881 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3882
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003883default-bind [param*]
3884 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3885
3886default-server [param*]
3887 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3888
3889 Arguments:
3890 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3891 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003892 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3893 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3894 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3895 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003896
3897 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3898
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003899enabled
3900 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3901 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003902
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003903log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003904 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3905 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3906 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3907 more details.
3908
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003909peer <peername> [<address>]:port [param*]
3910peer <peername> /<path> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003911 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3912 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003913 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003914 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on the provided
3915 address. Otherwise, the address defines where to connect to in order to join
3916 the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003917 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003918
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003919 During a soft restart, local peer address is used by the old instance to
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003920 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3921
3922 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003923 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3924 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3925 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003926
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003927 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3928 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003929
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003930 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3931 "server" keyword explanation below).
3932
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003933server <peername> [<address>:<port>] [param*]
3934server <peername> [/<path>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003935 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003936 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003937 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, the address
3938 parameter must not be present; it must be provided on a "bind" line (see
3939 "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003940
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003941 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3942 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3943 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3944 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3945 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003946
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003947 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003948 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003949 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003950 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3951 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3952 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003953
3954 backend mybackend
3955 mode tcp
3956 balance roundrobin
3957 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3958 stick on src
3959
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003960 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3961 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003962
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003963 Example:
3964 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003965 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3966 default-server ssl verify none
3967 server haproxy1 #local peer
3968 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3969 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003970
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003971shards <shards>
3972
3973 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3974 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3975 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3976 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3977 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003978
3979table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3980 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3981
3982 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3983 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003984 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003985 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3986 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3987 "stick-table" keyword).
3988
3989 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3990 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3991 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3992 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3993 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3994 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3995 of the stick-table name as follows:
3996
3997 peers mypeers
3998 peer A ...
3999 peer B ...
4000 table t1 ...
4001
4002 frontend fe1
4003 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
4004
4005 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
4006 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
4007
4008 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
4009 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
4010 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
4011 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
4012 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
4013 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
4014 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
4015
4016 peers mypeers
4017 peer A ...
4018 peer B ...
4019 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
4020
4021 backend t1
4022 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
4023
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004024 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01004025 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
4026 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
4027
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090040283.6. Mailers
4029------------
4030It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
4031If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
4032in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
4033
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02004034mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004035 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
4036 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
4037
4038mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
4039 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
4040
4041 Example:
4042 mailers mymailers
4043 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
4044 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
4045
4046 backend mybackend
4047 mode tcp
4048 balance roundrobin
4049
4050 email-alert mailers mymailers
4051 email-alert from test1@horms.org
4052 email-alert to test2@horms.org
4053
4054 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
4055 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
4056
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01004057timeout mail <time>
4058 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
4059 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
4060 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
4061 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
4062
4063 Example:
4064 mailers mymailers
4065 timeout mail 20s
4066 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004067
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020040683.7. Programs
4069-------------
4070In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
4071master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
4072managed the same way as the workers.
4073
4074During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
4075sequence as a worker:
4076
4077 - the master is re-executed
4078 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
4079 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
4080 instance of the program
4081
4082During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
4083
4084program <name>
4085 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
4086 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
4087 the management guide).
4088
4089command <command> [arguments*]
4090 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
4091 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
4092 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
4093 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
4094
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08004095user <user name>
4096 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
4097 See also "group".
4098
4099group <group name>
4100 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
4101 See also "user".
4102
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02004103option start-on-reload
4104no option start-on-reload
4105 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
4106 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
4107 program section.
4108
4109
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010041103.8. HTTP-errors
4111----------------
4112
4113It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
4114imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
4115several places and can be fully or partially imported.
4116
4117http-errors <name>
4118 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
4119 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
4120
4121errorfile <code> <file>
4122 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
4123
4124 Arguments :
4125 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004126 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004127 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004128
4129 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
4130 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
4131 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
4132 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4133 before any chroot is performed.
4134
4135 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
4136
4137 Example:
4138 http-errors website-1
4139 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
4140 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
4141 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4142
4143 http-errors website-2
4144 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
4145 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
4146 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4147
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020041483.9. Rings
4149----------
4150
4151It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
4152servers or traces.
4153
4154ring <ringname>
4155 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
4156
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004157backing-file <path>
4158 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
4159 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
4160 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
4161 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
4162 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
4163 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
4164 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
4165
4166 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
4167 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
4168 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
4169 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02004170 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
4171 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
4172 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
4173 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
4174 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
4175 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
4176 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
4177 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
4178 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
4179 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
4180 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
4181 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004182
4183 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
4184 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
4185 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
4186 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
4187 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
4188 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
4189 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
4190
4191 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
4192 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
4193 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
4194
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004195description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004196 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004197 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
4198
4199format <format>
4200 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
4201
4202 Arguments:
4203 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
4204 one of the following :
4205
4206 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
4207 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
4208 designed to be used with a local log server.
4209
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004210 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
4211 field is stripped. This is the default.
4212 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
4213 rfc3164.
4214
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004215 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
4216 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4217 used in containers or during development, where the severity
4218 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
4219 is the default.
4220
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004221 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004222 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
4223
4224 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
4225 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
4226
4227 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4228 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
4229 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
4230 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
4231 logger consumes.
4232
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02004233 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
4234 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
4235 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
4236 with a local log server.
4237
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004238 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4239 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
4240 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4241 used with a local log server.
4242
4243maxlen <length>
4244 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
4245 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
4246 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
4247
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004248server <name> <address> [param*]
4249 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
4250 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
4251 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
4252 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
4253 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
4254 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
4255 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
4256 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
4257 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004258 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
4259 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004260
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004261size <size>
4262 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
4263 set to BUFSIZE.
4264
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004265timeout connect <timeout>
4266 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
4267
4268 Arguments :
4269 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4270 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4271 as explained at the top of this document.
4272
4273timeout server <timeout>
4274 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
4275
4276 Arguments :
4277 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4278 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4279 as explained at the top of this document.
4280
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004281 Example:
4282 global
4283 log ring@myring local7
4284
4285 ring myring
4286 description "My local buffer"
4287 format rfc3164
4288 maxlen 1200
4289 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004290 timeout connect 5s
4291 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004292 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004293
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020042943.10. Log forwarding
4295-------------------
4296
4297It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004298HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004299
4300log-forward <name>
4301 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
4302
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004303backlog <conns>
4304 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4305 on connections accept.
4306
4307bind <addr> [param*]
4308 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02004309 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
4310 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
4311 syslog protocol over TCP.
4312 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004313 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
4314
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02004315dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004316 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
4317 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
4318 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
4319 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02004320 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004321
4322log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01004323log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004324 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
4325 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
4326 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004327 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004328 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
4329 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
4330 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004331 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004332
4333 Example:
4334 global
4335 log stderr format iso local7
4336
4337 ring myring
4338 description "My local buffer"
4339 format rfc5424
4340 maxlen 1200
4341 size 32764
4342 timeout connect 5s
4343 timeout server 10s
4344 # syslog tcp server
4345 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
4346
4347 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004348 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
4349 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004350 # all messages on stderr
4351 log global
4352 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
4353 log ring@myring local0
4354 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
4355 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
4356 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
4357 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
4358 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004359
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004360maxconn <conns>
4361 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
4362 10 is the default.
4363
4364timeout client <timeout>
4365 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
4366
Lukas Tribus5c11eb82024-01-30 21:17:44 +000043673.11. HTTPClient tuning
4368-----------------------
4369
4370HTTPClient is an internal HTTP library, it can be used by various subsystems,
4371for example in LUA scripts. HTTPClient is not used in the data path, in other
4372words it has nothing with HTTP traffic passing through HAProxy.
4373
4374httpclient.resolvers.disabled <on|off>
4375 Disable the DNS resolution of the httpclient. Prevent the creation of the
4376 "default" resolvers section.
4377
4378 Default value is off.
4379
4380httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
4381 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
4382 to resolve.
4383
4384 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
4385 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
4386
4387 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
4388 configuration error if it fails to load.
4389
4390httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
4391 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
4392 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
4393 option is "ipv6".
4394
4395httpclient.retries <number>
4396 This option allows to configure the number of retries attempt of the
4397 httpclient when a request failed. This does the same as the "retries" keyword
4398 in a backend.
4399
4400 Default value is 3.
4401
4402httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
4403 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
4404 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
4405 server line.
4406
4407 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
4408 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
4409 will be disabled for the httpclient.
4410
4411 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
4412 configuration error if it fails.
4413
4414httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
4415 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
4416 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
4417
4418 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
4419 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
4420
4421 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
4422 configuration error if it fails.
4423
4424httpclient.timeout.connect <timeout>
4425 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt by default for the
4426 httpclient.
4427
4428 Arguments :
4429 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4430 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4431 as explained at the top of this document.
4432
4433 The default value is 5000ms.
4434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044354. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004436----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004437
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004438Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004439 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
4440 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4441 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4442 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004443
4444A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
4445connections.
4446
4447A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
4448to forward incoming connections.
4449
4450A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
4451parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
4452
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004453A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
4454ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
4455sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
4456the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
4457explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
4458from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
4459"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
4460for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
4461to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
4462optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
4463are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
4464any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
4465names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
4466that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
4467duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02004468names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
4469is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
4470implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
4471encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
4472adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004473
4474Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
4475settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
4476of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
4477profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
4478timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
4479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004480All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
4481'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
4482case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
4483
4484Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
4485logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
4486proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4487However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4488name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4489
4490Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4491and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004492bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004493protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4494modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4495arbitrary criteria.
4496
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004497In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4498a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004499the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004500
4501 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4502 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4503 between responses and new requests.
4504
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004505 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4506 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4507 client-facing connection remains open.
4508
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004509 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4510 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004511
4512The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4513frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4514following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004515weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004516
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004517 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004518
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004519 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4520 ----+-----+-----+----
4521 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4522 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004523 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4524 ----+-----+-----+----
4525 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004526
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004527It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004528only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4529within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004530as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004531content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004532and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4533possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004534
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004535There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004536first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004537processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004538second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004539protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4540is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4541new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004542to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004543process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4544already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4545HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4546evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4547one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4548
4549There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4550performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4551tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4552preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4553analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4554HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4555header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4556mitigate this drawback.
4557
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004558There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004559method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4560set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4561in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4562is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4563to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4564above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4565to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4566"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4567frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4568frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4569as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4570upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4571on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4572the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4573upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4574frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4575remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020045774.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4578--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004579
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004580The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4581limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4582they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4583limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004584marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004585option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004586and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4587with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004588specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4589sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4590anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004591
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004592
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004593 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4594------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004595acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004596backlog X X X -
4597balance X - X X
4598bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004599capture cookie - X X -
4600capture request header - X X -
4601capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004602clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4603clitcpka-idle X X X -
4604clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004605compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004606cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004607declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004608default-server X - X X
4609default_backend X X X -
4610description - X X X
4611disabled X X X X
4612dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004613email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004614email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004615email-alert mailers X X X X
4616email-alert myhostname X X X X
4617email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004618enabled X X X X
4619errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004620errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004621errorloc X X X X
4622errorloc302 X X X X
4623-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4624errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004625error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004626force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004627filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004628fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004629hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004630http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004631http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004632http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004633http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004634http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004635http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004636http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004637http-check set-var X - X X
4638http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004639http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004640http-request X (!) X X X
4641http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004642http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONdf238c32023-01-12 15:59:27 +01004643http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004644id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004645ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004646load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004647log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004648log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004649log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004650log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004651max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb8e4f222023-11-29 10:13:18 +01004652max-session-srv-conns X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004653maxconn X X X -
4654mode X X X X
4655monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004656monitor-uri X X X -
4657option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4658option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4659option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4660option allbackups (*) X - X X
4661option checkcache (*) X - X X
4662option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4663option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004664option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004665option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4666option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004667-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4668option forwardfor X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01004669option forwarded (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004670option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4671option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004672option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004673option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004674option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004675option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004676option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004677option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004678option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4679option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4680option httpchk X - X X
4681option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004682option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004683option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004684option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004685option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004686option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004687option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4688option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4689option logasap (*) X X X -
4690option mysql-check X - X X
4691option nolinger (*) X X X X
4692option originalto X X X X
4693option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004694option pgsql-check X - X X
4695option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004696option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004697option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004698option smtpchk X - X X
4699option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4700option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4701option splice-request (*) X X X X
4702option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +01004703option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004704option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4705option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4706-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004707option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004708option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4709option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4710option tcpka X X X X
Nathan Wehrman26224d22024-08-13 10:36:28 -07004711option tcplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004712option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004713option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004714external-check command X - X X
4715external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004716persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4717rate-limit sessions X X X -
4718redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004719-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004720retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004721retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004722server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004723server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004724server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004725source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004726srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4727srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4728srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004729stats admin - X X X
4730stats auth X X X X
4731stats enable X X X X
4732stats hide-version X X X X
4733stats http-request - X X X
4734stats realm X X X X
4735stats refresh X X X X
4736stats scope X X X X
4737stats show-desc X X X X
4738stats show-legends X X X X
4739stats show-node X X X X
4740stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004741-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4742stick match - - X X
4743stick on - - X X
4744stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004745stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004746stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004747tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004748tcp-check connect X - X X
4749tcp-check expect X - X X
4750tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004751tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004752tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004753tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004754tcp-check set-var X - X X
4755tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004756tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4757tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4758tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4759tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4760tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4761tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004762timeout check X - X X
4763timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004764timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004765timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004766timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4767timeout http-request X X X X
4768timeout queue X - X X
4769timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004770timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004771timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004772timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004773transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004774unique-id-format X X X -
4775unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004776use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004777use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004778use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004779------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4780 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004781
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047834.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4784---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004785
4786This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4787
4788
4789acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4790 Declare or complete an access list.
4791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004792 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4793
4794 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4795 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4796 using it.
4797
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004798 Example:
4799 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4800 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4801 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004803 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004804
4805
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004806backlog <conns>
4807 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4809 yes | yes | yes | no
4810 Arguments :
4811 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4812 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004813 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004814
4815 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4816 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4817 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4818 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4819 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4820 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4821 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4822 backlog parameter.
4823
4824 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4825 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4826 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4827
4828 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4829
4830
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004831balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004832balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004833 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4835 yes | no | yes | yes
4836 Arguments :
4837 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4838 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4839 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4840 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4841
4842 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4843 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4844 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4845 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004846 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004847 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004848 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4849 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4850 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4851 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4852 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4853 it, so that you don't worry.
4854
4855 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4856 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4857 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4858 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4859 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4860 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4861 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4862 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004863
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004864 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4865 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4866 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4867 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4868 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4869 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4870 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004871 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4872 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4873 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004874
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004875 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004876 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004877 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4878 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004879 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004880 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4881 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4882 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4883 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4884 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004885 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4886 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4887 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4888 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4889 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4890 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004891
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004892 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4893 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4894 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4895 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4896 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4897 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4898 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4899 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4900 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4901 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4902 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4903 changed using "hash-type".
4904
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004905 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4906 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4907 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4908 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4909 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4910 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4911 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4912 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004913 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004914 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004915 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4916 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004917 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004918
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004919 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4920 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4921 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4922 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4923 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4924 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4925 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4926 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4927 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4928 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4929 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4930 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004931
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004932 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004933 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4934 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4935 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4936 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4937 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4938 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4939 URIs start with a leading "/".
4940
4941 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4942 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4943 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4944 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4945
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004946 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4947 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4948 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004949 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4950 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004952 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004953 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4954
4955 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004956 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4957 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004958 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4959 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4960 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4961 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004962 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004963 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4964 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004965
4966 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4967 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4968 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4969 server will receive the request.
4970
4971 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4972 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4973 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4974 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4975 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004976 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4977 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004978 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4979 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004980
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004981 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4982 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4983 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4984 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4985 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004987 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004988 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4989 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4990 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4991
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004992 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4993 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004994 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4995 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004996
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004997 random
4998 random(<draws>)
4999 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005000 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
5001 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
5002 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
5003 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01005004 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
5005 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
5006 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
5007 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
5008 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
5009 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
5010 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
5011 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
5012 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
5013 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
5014 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
5015 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
5016 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
5017 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
5018 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
5019 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
5020 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
5021 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
5022 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
5023 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005024
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005025 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005026 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005027 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
5028 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01005029 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005030 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
5031 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
5032 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005033 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005034 used instead.
5035
5036 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
5037 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
5038 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01005039 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005040
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005041 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
5042 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02005043 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
5044 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005045
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005046 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02005047 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
5048 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005049
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01005050 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
5051 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
5052 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005053
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02005054 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05005055 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02005056 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
5057 NTLM relies on.
5058
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005059 Examples :
5060 balance roundrobin
5061 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005062 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01005063 balance hdr(User-Agent)
5064 balance hdr(host)
5065 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02005066 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
5067 balance hash var(req.client_id)
5068 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005069
5070 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
5071 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
5072
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005073 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005074 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
5075 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
5076 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005077 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005078
5079 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
5080 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
5081 defaults to 16 kB.
5082
5083 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
5084 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
5085
5086 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
5087 Round Robin.
5088
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005089 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005090 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
5091 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
5092 actually appeared in the first chunk).
5093
5094 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
5095
5096 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005097 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005098 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
5099 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
5100 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005101
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02005102 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005103
5104
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005105bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
5106bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005107 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
5108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5109 no | yes | yes | no
5110 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01005111 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
5112 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
5113 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
5114 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005115 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
Amaury Denoyelleb19d22e2024-02-15 18:43:44 +01005116 that for UDP, specific OS features are required when binding
5117 on multiple addresses to ensure the correct network interface
5118 and source address will be used on response. In other way,
5119 for QUIC listeners only bind on multiple addresses if running
5120 with a modern enough systems.
5121
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005122 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
5123 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
5124 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
5125 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5126 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5127 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005128 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005129 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
5130 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005131 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005132 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5133 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005134 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005135 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5136 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005137 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02005138 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01005139 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
5140 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
5141 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02005142 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
5143 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
5144 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
5145 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005146 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005147 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
Artur Pydoe6ca4182023-06-06 11:49:59 +02005148 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.socket-owner" on
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005149 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
5150 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
5151 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
5152 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
5153 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005154 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01005155 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
5156 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005157
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005158 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5159 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
5160 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01005161
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005162 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
5163 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005164 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
5165 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
5166 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005167 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
5168 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
5169 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
5170 the range.
5171
5172 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
5173 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
5174 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
5175 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
5176 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
5177 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
5178 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005179 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005180 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005181
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005182 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005183 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005184 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
5185 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
5186 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
5187 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
5188 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
5189 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
5190
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005191 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
5192 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
5193 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
5194 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005195
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005196 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
5197 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
5198 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
5199 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
5200 in a frontend.
5201
5202 Example :
5203 listen http_proxy
5204 bind :80,:443
5205 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005206 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005207
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005208 listen http_https_proxy
5209 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02005210 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005211
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005212 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
5213 bind ipv6@:80
5214 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
5215 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
5216
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005217 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005218 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005219
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005220 listen h3_quic_proxy
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +02005221 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005222
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02005223 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
5224 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
5225 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
5226 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
5227 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
5228
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005229 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005230 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005231
5232
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005233capture cookie <name> len <length>
5234 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
5235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5236 no | yes | yes | no
5237 Arguments :
5238 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
5239 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
5240 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
5241 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005242 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005243
5244 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
5245 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
5246 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
5247 right if it exceeds <length>.
5248
5249 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
5250 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
5251 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
5252 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
5253
5254 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
5255 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
5256 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
5257
5258 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
5259 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
5260 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01005261 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
5262 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
5263 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005264
5265 Example:
5266 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
5267
5268 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005269 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005270
5271
5272capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005273 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5275 no | yes | yes | no
5276 Arguments :
5277 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005278 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005279 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
5280 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5281 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5282
5283 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5284 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5285 it exceeds <length>.
5286
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005287 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005288 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
5289 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005290 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
5291 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
5292 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
5293 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005294 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005295 environments to find where the request came from.
5296
5297 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
5298 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
5299 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
5300 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005301
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005302 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
5303 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5304 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5305 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5306 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005307
5308 Example:
5309 capture request header Host len 15
5310 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01005311 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005313 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005314 about logging.
5315
5316
5317capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005318 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5320 no | yes | yes | no
5321 Arguments :
5322 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005323 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005324 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
5325 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5326 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5327
5328 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5329 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5330 it exceeds <length>.
5331
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005332 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005333 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
5334 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
5335 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005336 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
5337 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
5338 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
5339 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005340
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005341 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
5342 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5343 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5344 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5345 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005346
5347 Example:
5348 capture response header Content-length len 9
5349 capture response header Location len 15
5350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005351 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005352 about logging.
5353
5354
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005355clitcpka-cnt <count>
5356 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
5357 the connection on the client side.
5358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5359 yes | yes | yes | no
5360 Arguments :
5361 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
5362
5363 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
5364 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005365 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5366 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005367
5368 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
5369
5370
5371clitcpka-idle <timeout>
5372 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
5373 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
5374 client side.
5375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5376 yes | yes | yes | no
5377 Arguments :
5378 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
5379 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
5380 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
5381 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
5382
5383 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
5384 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005385 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5386 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005387
5388 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
5389
5390
5391clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
5392 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
5393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5394 yes | yes | yes | no
5395 Arguments :
5396 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
5397 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
5398 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
5399 document.
5400
5401 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
5402 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005403 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5404 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005405
5406 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
5407
5408
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005409compression algo <algorithm> ...
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005410compression algo-req <algorithm>
5411compression algo-res <algorithm>
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005412compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005413 Enable HTTP compression.
5414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5415 yes | yes | yes | yes
5416 Arguments :
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005417 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5418 responses (legacy keyword)
5419 algo-req is followed by compression algorithm for request (only one is
5420 provided).
5421 algo-res is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5422 responses.
5423 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5424 responses (legacy keyword).
5425 type-req is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5426 requests.
5427 type-res is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5428 responses.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005429
5430 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005431 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
5432 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
5433 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005434
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005435 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005436 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005437
5438 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
5439 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
5440 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
5441 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
5442 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005443 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005444
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005445 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
5446 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
5447 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
5448 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
5449 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
5450 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
5451 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005452 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005453
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04005454 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005455 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005456 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005457 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005458 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005459 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005460 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02005461
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005462 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005463 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
5464 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02005465 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005466 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005467 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
5468 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
5469 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
5470 "multipart"
5471 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
5472 header
5473 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
5474 and later
5475 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
5476 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005477 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005478
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01005479 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005480
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005481 Examples :
5482 compression algo gzip
5483 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005484
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005485 See also : "compression offload", "compression direction"
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01005486
5487compression offload
5488 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
5489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5490 no | yes | yes | yes
5491
5492 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
5493 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
5494 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
5495 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
5496 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
5497 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
5498 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
5499 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
5500 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
5501 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
5502 then be used for such scenarios.
5503
5504 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5505 option is ignored.
5506
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005507 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression direction"
5508
5509compression direction <direction>
5510 Makes haproxy able to compress both requests and responses.
5511 Valid values are "request", to compress only requests, "response", to
5512 compress only responses, or "both", when you want to compress both.
5513 The default value is "response".
5514
5515 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression offload"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005516
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005517cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005518 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5519 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005520 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005521 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5523 yes | no | yes | yes
5524 Arguments :
5525 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5526 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5527 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5528 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5529 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5530 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005531 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005532 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5533 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5534
5535 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005536 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005537 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5538 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5539 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5540 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005541 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5542 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005543 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005544 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5545 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005546
5547 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005548 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005549
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005550 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005551 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005552 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005553 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005554 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5555 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5556 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5557 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5558 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5559 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5560 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005561
5562 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5563 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5564 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5565 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5566 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5567 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5568 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5569 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5570 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005571 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005572 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5573 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5574 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005575
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005576 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5577 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5578 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005579 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5580 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5581 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5582 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005583 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5584 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5585 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005586
5587 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5588 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5589 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5590 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5591 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5592 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5593 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5594 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5595 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5596
5597 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5598 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5599 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5600 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5601 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5602 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5603 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5604 persistence cookie in the cache.
5605 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5606
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005607 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5608 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005609 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005610 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5611 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005612 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005613 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5614 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5615 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5616 they logout.
5617
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005618 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005619 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5620 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5621 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5622
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005623 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005624 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5625 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5626 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5627 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5628 this attribute.
5629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005630 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005631 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005632 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5633 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5634 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5635 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5636 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5637 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005638
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005639 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5640 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5641 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5642 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5643 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5644 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5645 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5646 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005647 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005648 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5649 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5650 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5651 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5652 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5653 the site.
5654
5655 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5656 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5657 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5658 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5659 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5660 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5661 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5662 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5663 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5664 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5665 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5666 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5667 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005668 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005669 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5670 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5671
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005672 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5673 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5674 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5675 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5676 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5677 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5678
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005679 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005680 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5681 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5682 repeated.
5683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005684 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5685 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5686 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5687 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005688
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005689 Examples :
5690 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5691 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5692 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005693 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005694
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005695 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005696
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005697
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005698declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5699 Declares a capture slot.
5700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5701 no | yes | yes | no
5702 Arguments:
5703 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5704
5705 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5706 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5707 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5708 for use in the response.
5709
5710 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005711 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005712 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5713
5714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005715default-server [param*]
5716 Change default options for a server in a backend
5717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5718 yes | no | yes | yes
5719 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005720 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5721 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5722 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5723 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005724
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005725 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005726 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5727
5728 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005729
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005731default_backend <backend>
5732 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5734 yes | yes | yes | no
5735 Arguments :
5736 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5737
5738 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5739 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5740 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5741 will catch all undetermined requests.
5742
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005743 Example :
5744
5745 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5746 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5747 default_backend dynamic
5748
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005749 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005751
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005752description <string>
5753 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5755 no | yes | yes | yes
5756 Arguments : string
5757
5758 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5759 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5760 it describes.
5761 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5762
5763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005764disabled
5765 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5767 yes | yes | yes | yes
5768 Arguments : none
5769
5770 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5771 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5772 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5773 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5774 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5775 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5776 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5777
5778 See also : "enabled"
5779
5780
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005781dispatch <address>:<port>
5782 Set a default server address
5783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5784 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005785 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005786
5787 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5788 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5789 during start-up.
5790
5791 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5792 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5793 possible with normal servers.
5794
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005795 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005796 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5797 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5798 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5799 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5800
5801 See also : "server"
5802
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005803
5804dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5805 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5807 yes | no | yes | yes
5808 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5809
5810 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005811 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005812 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5813 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005814 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005815 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005817enabled
5818 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5820 yes | yes | yes | yes
5821 Arguments : none
5822
5823 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5824 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5825
5826 See also : "disabled"
5827
5828
5829errorfile <code> <file>
5830 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5832 yes | yes | yes | yes
5833 Arguments :
5834 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005835 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005836 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005837
5838 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005839 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005840 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005841 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5842 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005843
5844 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5845 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5846 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5847
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005848 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5849
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005850 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5851 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5852 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5853 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5854 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5855 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5856 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5857 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5858 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005859
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005860 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5861 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5862 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005863 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005864 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5865
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005866 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005867
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005868 Example :
5869 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005870 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005871 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5872 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5873
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005874
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005875errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5876 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5877 section.
5878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5879 yes | yes | yes | yes
5880 Arguments :
5881 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5882
5883 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005884 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005885 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5886 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005887
5888 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5889 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5890 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5891 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5892 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005893 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005894 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5895
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005896 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5897 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005898
5899 Example :
5900 errorfiles generic
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01005901 errorfiles site-1 403 404
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005902
5903
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005904errorloc <code> <url>
5905errorloc302 <code> <url>
5906 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5908 yes | yes | yes | yes
5909 Arguments :
5910 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005911 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005912 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005913
5914 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5915 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5916 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5917 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005918 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005919
5920 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5921 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5922 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5923
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005924 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5925
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005926 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5927 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5928 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5929 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005930 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005931 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5932 request.
5933
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005934 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005935
5936
5937errorloc303 <code> <url>
5938 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5940 yes | yes | yes | yes
5941 Arguments :
5942 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005943 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005944 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005945
5946 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5947 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5948 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5949 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005950 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005951
5952 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5953 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5954 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5955
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005956 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5957
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005958 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5959 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5960 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5961 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005962 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005963
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005964 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005965
5966
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005967email-alert from <emailaddr>
5968 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005969 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005970 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5971 yes | yes | yes | yes
5972
5973 Arguments :
5974
5975 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5976
5977 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5978 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5979
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005980 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005981 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5982 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005983
5984
5985email-alert level <level>
5986 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5987 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5988 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5989 yes | yes | yes | yes
5990
5991 Arguments :
5992
5993 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5994 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5995 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5996
5997 By default level is alert
5998
5999 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
6000 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
6001 for the proxy.
6002
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09006003 Alerts are sent when :
6004
6005 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
6006 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
6007 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
6008 is notice or lower
6009 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
6010 and a health check status update occurs
6011
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09006012 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
6013 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006014 section 3.6 about mailers.
6015
6016
6017email-alert mailers <mailersect>
6018 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
6019 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6020 yes | yes | yes | yes
6021
6022 Arguments :
6023
6024 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
6025
6026 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
6027 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
6028
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09006029 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
6030 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006031
6032
6033email-alert myhostname <hostname>
6034 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
6035 mailers.
6036 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6037 yes | yes | yes | yes
6038
6039 Arguments :
6040
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01006041 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006042
6043 By default the systems hostname is used.
6044
6045 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
6046 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
6047 for the proxy.
6048
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09006049 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
6050 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006051
6052
6053email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006054 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006055 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
6056 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6057 yes | yes | yes | yes
6058
6059 Arguments :
6060
6061 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
6062
6063 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
6064 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
6065
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09006066 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006067 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
6068
6069
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02006070error-log-format <string>
6071 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
6072 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6073 yes | yes | yes | no
6074
6075 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
6076 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
6077 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
6078 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01006079 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
6080
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02006081 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02006082 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.6 which covers the custom log
6083 format string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02006084
6085 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
6086 directives.
6087
6088
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006089force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6090 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
6091 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006092 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006093
6094 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
6095 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
6096 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
6097 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
6098 marked down for maintenance operations.
6099
6100 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6101 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
6102 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
6103 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
6104 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
6105 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
6106 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
6107 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
6108 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
6109
6110 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6111 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
6112 is used.
6113
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006114 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02006115 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006117
6118filter <name> [param*]
6119 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
6120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6121 no | yes | yes | yes
6122 Arguments :
6123 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
6124 referenced in section 9.
6125
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006126 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006127 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006128 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
6129 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006130
6131 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
6132 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
6133
6134 Example:
6135 listen
6136 bind *:80
6137
6138 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
6139 filter compression
6140 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
6141
6142 compression algo gzip
6143 compression offload
6144
6145 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6146
6147 See also : section 9.
6148
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006149
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006150fullconn <conns>
6151 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
6152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6153 yes | no | yes | yes
6154 Arguments :
6155 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
6156 servers use the maximal number of connections.
6157
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006158 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006159 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006160 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006161 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
6162 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
6163 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
6164 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
6165 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006166 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006167
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006168 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006169 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01006170 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
6171 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
6172 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006173
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006174 Example :
6175 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
6176 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
6177 # connections.
6178 backend dynamic
6179 fullconn 10000
6180 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6181 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6182
6183 See also : "maxconn", "server"
6184
6185
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006186hash-balance-factor <factor>
6187 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
6188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6189 yes | no | no | yes
6190 Arguments :
6191 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
6192 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006193 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006194
6195 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
6196 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
6197 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
6198 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
6199 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
6200 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
6201 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
6202
6203 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
6204 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
6205 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
6206 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
6207 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
6208
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02006209 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
6210 consistent hashing mechanism.
6211
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006212 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
6213
6214
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006215hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006216 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
6217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6218 yes | no | yes | yes
6219 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006220 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
6221 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006222
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006223 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
6224 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
6225 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
6226 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
6227 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
6228 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
6229 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
6230 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
6231 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
6232 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01006233
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006234 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
6235 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
6236 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
6237 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
6238 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
6239 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
6240 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
6241 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
6242 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
6243 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
6244 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
6245 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
6246 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006247 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
6248 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006249
6250 <function> is the hash function to be used :
6251
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006252 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006253 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
6254 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
6255 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006256 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
6257 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
6258 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006259
6260 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
6261 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006262 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
6263 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
6264 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
6265 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
6266
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006267 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01006268 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
6269 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
6270 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
6271 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
6272 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
6273 parameter.
6274
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01006275 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
6276 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
6277 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
6278 used on strings.
6279
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006280 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
6281
6282 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
6283 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
6284 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
6285 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
6286 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
6287 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
6288 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
6289 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
6290 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
6291 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
6292 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
6293 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006294
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006295 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
6296 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
6297 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006298
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006299 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006300
6301
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006302http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6303 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
6304 ones).
6305
6306 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006307 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006308
6309 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
6310 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
6311 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6312 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6313 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6314 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6315
6316 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
6317 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
6318 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
6319
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006320 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6321 supported:
6322 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6323 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006324 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006325 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006326 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006327 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006328 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6329 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006330 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006331 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6332 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6333 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6334 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6335 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006336 - set-header <name> <fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006337 - set-log-level <level>
6338 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006339 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006340 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6341 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006342 - strict-mode { on | off }
6343 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6344
6345 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006346
6347 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
6348 instance.
6349
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006350 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6351 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6352 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6353 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6354 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6355 a defaults section defining such rules.
6356
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006357 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
6358 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
6359 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
6360
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006361 Example:
6362 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
6363 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
6364 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
6365
6366http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6367
6368 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006369 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
6370 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006371
Christopher Fauletd9d36b82023-01-05 10:25:30 +01006372http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6373
6374 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6375 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
6376
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006377http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6378
6379 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6380 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
6381 complete description.
6382
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006383http-after-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6384
6385 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
6386 del-acl" for a complete description.
6387
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006388http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006389
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006390 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
6391 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006392
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006393http-after-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6394
6395 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6396 del-map" for a complete description.
6397
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006398http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6399 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6400
6401 This works like "http-response replace-header".
6402
6403 Example:
6404 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
6405
6406 # applied to:
6407 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6408
6409 # outputs:
6410 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6411
6412 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
6413
6414http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6415 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6416
6417 This works like "http-response replace-value".
6418
6419 Example:
6420 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
6421
6422 # applied to:
6423 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
6424
6425 # outputs:
6426 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
6427
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006428http-after-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6429 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6430
6431 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
6432 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
6433 a complete description.
6434
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006435http-after-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6436http-after-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6437http-after-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6438
6439 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
6440 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
6441 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
6442 description.
6443
6444http-after-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6445 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6446http-after-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6447 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6448
6449 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
6450 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02006451 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006452
6453http-after-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6454
6455 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
6456 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
6457
6458http-after-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6459
6460 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6461 set-map" for a complete description.
6462
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006463http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6464
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006465 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
6466 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6467 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6468 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006469
6470http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6471 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6472
6473 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05006474 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006475 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006476
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006477http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6478http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006479
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006480 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6481 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
6482 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006483
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006484http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006485
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006486 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
6487 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006488
6489http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6490
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006491 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
6492 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006493
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006494
6495http-check comment <string>
6496 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
6497 it fails.
6498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6499 yes | no | yes | yes
6500
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006501 Arguments :
6502 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
6503 rule fails.
6504
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006505 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
6506 user-friendly error reporting.
6507
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006508 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006509 "http-check expect".
6510
6511
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006512http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
6513 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01006514 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006515 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
6516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6517 yes | no | yes | yes
6518
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006519 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006520 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6521
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006522 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006523 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006524
6525 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
6526 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6527 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
6528 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
6529
6530 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
6531
6532 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6533
6534 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
6535
6536 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6537
6538 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
6539
6540 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
6541 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
6542 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
6543 is used.
6544
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006545 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
6546 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
6547 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
6548 haproxy -vv.
6549
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006550 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
6551
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006552 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
6553 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
6554 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
6555 different ports or with different servers.
6556
6557 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6558 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
6559 the port with a "http-check connect".
6560
6561 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6562 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6563 do.
6564
6565 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6566 unset-var or comment rules.
6567
6568 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006569 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6570 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6571 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6572 option httpchk
6573
6574 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006575 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006576 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006577 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006578 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006579 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006580
6581 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6582
6583 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006584
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006586http-check disable-on-404
6587 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006589 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006590 Arguments : none
6591
6592 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6593 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6594 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6595 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6596 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6597 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6598 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6599 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006600 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6601 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006602 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6603 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6604 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006605
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006606 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006607
6608
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006609http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006610 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6611 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6612 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006613 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006615 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006616
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006617 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006618 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6619
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006620 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6621 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6622 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6623 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6624 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6625 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6626 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6627 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6628 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6629 result is always conclusive.
6630
6631 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6632 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6633 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006634 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6635 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006636 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6637 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006638 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6639 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6640 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006641
6642 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6643 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006644 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6645 supported :
6646 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6647 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006648 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6649 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6650 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6651 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6652 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006653
6654 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6655 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006656 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6657 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6658 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6659 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006660 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6661
6662 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6663 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6664 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6665 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6666
6667 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6668 informational message reported in logs if an error
6669 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6670 log-format string.
6671
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006672 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006673 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6674 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006675 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6676 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6677 details on the supported keywords.
6678
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006679 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6680 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6681 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6682 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006683
6684 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6685 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6686 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6687 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6688 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6689
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006690 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6691 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6692 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6693 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6694 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6695 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6696 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006697
6698 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006699 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006700 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6701 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6702 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6703 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6704
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006705 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6706 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006707 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6708 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6709 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6710 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6711 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6712 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6713 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6714 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006715 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6716 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6717 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6718 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6719 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6720 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6721 insensitive on the header names.
6722
6723 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6724 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6725 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6726 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6727 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6728 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006729
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006730 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006731 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006732 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6733 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6734 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6735 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6736 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006737 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006738 trace).
6739
6740 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006741 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006742 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6743 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6744 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6745 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6746 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006747 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006748
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006749 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6750 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6751 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6752 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6753 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6754 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6755
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006756 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006757 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006758 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6759 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6760 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6761 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6762 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6763 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6764
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006765 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6766 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6767 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6768 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6769 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006770
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006771 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6772 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6773
6774 Examples :
6775 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006776 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006777
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006778 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6779 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6780
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006781 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006782 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006783
6784 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006785 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006786
6787 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006788 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006789
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006790 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006791 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006792
6793
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006794http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006795 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6796 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006797 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6798 health checks.
6799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6800 yes | no | yes | yes
6801 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006802 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6803
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006804 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6805 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6806 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6807 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6808 to invent non-standard ones.
6809
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006810 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6811 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6812 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6813 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6814
6815 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6816 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6817 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6818 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006819
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006820 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006821 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006822 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006823 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6824 to add it.
6825
6826 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6827 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6828 to the log-format rules.
6829
6830 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6831 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6832 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006833
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006834 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6835 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6836 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6837 request.
6838
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006839 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6840 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6841 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006842 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6843 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6844 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6845 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006846 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006847
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006848 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006849 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6850 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006851
6852 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6853 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6854 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6855 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6856 configured request authority.
6857
6858 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6859 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006860
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006861 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006862
6863
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006864http-check send-state
6865 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6867 yes | no | yes | yes
6868 Arguments : none
6869
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006870 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006871 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006872 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6873 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6874 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006875
6876 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6877 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6878 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6879 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6880 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006881 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6882 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6883 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6884
6885 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6886 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6887 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6888
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006889 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6890 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6891 checked in multiple backends.
6892
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006893 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006894 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6895
6896 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6897 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6898 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6899 one fails.
6900
6901 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6902 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6903 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6904
6905 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6906 server's queue.
6907
6908 Example of a header received by the application server :
6909 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6910 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6911
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006912 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6913 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006914
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006915
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006916http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6917http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006918 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006919 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6920 yes | no | yes | yes
6921
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006922 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006923 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6924 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6925 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6926 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6927 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6928 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6929 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6930 and '-'.
6931
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006932 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6933 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006934 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006935 conditions.
6936
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006937 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6938
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006939 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02006940 Log Format in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006941
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006942 Examples :
6943 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006944 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006945
6946
6947http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006948 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 yes | no | yes | yes
6951
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006952 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006953 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6954 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6955 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6956 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6957 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6958 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6959 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6960 and '-'.
6961
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006962 Examples :
6963 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006964
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006965
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006966http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6967 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6968 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6969 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6970 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6972 yes | yes | yes | yes
6973 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006974 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006975 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006976 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006977 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006978
6979 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6980 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6981 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6982 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6983
6984 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6985 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6986 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6987 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6988
6989 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6990 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6991 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6992 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6993 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6994 chroot is performed.
6995
6996 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6997 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6998 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6999 considered.
7000
7001 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
7002 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
7003 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
7004 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
7005 considered as a raw string.
7006
7007 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
7008 The content-type must always be set as argument to
7009 "content-type".
7010
7011 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
7012 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
7013 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
7014 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
7015 evaluated as a log-format string.
7016
7017 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
7018 payload. The content-type must always be set as
7019 argument to "content-type".
7020
7021 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
7022 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
7023 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
7024 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
7025
7026 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
7027 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
7028 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
7029 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
7030 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
7031 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
7032 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
7033 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
7034
7035 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
7036 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
7037 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
7038
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01007039 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
7040 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
7041 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
7042 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
7043 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
7044
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02007045 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
7046 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
7047
7048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007049http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007050 Access control for Layer 7 requests
7051
7052 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007053 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007054
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007055 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7056 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7057 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7058 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7059 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007060
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007061 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7062 supported:
7063 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7064 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7065 - allow
7066 - auth [realm <realm>]
7067 - cache-use <name>
7068 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
7069 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7070 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7071 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7072 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7073 - disable-l7-retry
7074 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
7075 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
7076 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
7077 - redirect <rule>
7078 - reject
7079 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7080 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7081 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7082 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7083 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7084 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01007085 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007086 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7087 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7088 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7089 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7090 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007091 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007092 - set-dst <expr>
7093 - set-dst-port <expr>
7094 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7095 - set-log-level <level>
7096 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7097 - set-mark <mark>
7098 - set-method <fmt>
7099 - set-nice <nice>
7100 - set-path <fmt>
7101 - set-pathq <fmt>
7102 - set-priority-class <expr>
7103 - set-priority-offset <expr>
7104 - set-query <fmt>
7105 - set-src <expr>
7106 - set-src-port <expr>
7107 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
7108 - set-tos <tos>
7109 - set-uri <fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01007110 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
7111 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007112 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007113 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007114 - strict-mode { on | off }
7115 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7116 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7117 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7118 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7119 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7120 - use-service <service-name>
7121 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7122 - wait-for-handshake
7123 - cache-use <name>
7124
7125 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007127 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007128
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007129 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7130 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7131 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7132 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7133 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7134 a defaults section defining such rules.
7135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007136 Example:
7137 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
7138 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
7139 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007140
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007141 http-request allow if nagios
7142 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
7143 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
7144 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01007145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007146 Example:
7147 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
7148 acl add path /addacl
7149 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007151 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007153 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
7154 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007156 Example:
7157 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
7158 acl setmap path /setmap
7159 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007161 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007163 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
7164 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007165
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007166 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7167 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007169http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007171 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7172 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7173 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7174 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7175 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
7176 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7177 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7178 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007179
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007180http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007182 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
7183 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
7184 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
7185 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
7186 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
7187 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
7188 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
7189 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007190
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007191http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007192
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007193 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01007194 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007196http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007198 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
7199 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
7200 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
7201 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
7202 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007203
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02007204 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
7205 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
7206 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
7207 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
7208 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
7209 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
7210 instead.
7211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007212 Example:
7213 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
7214 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007215
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007216http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007217
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007218 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007220http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
7221 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007223 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
7224 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
7225 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
7226 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
7227 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
7228 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
7229 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
7230 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
7231 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007233 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
7234 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
7235 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007236 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
7237
7238 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7239 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7240 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7241 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007242
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007243http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007245 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7246 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7247 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7248 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7249 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7250 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007251
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007252http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007253
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007254 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7255 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7256 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7257 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7258 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007259
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007260http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007262 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7263 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7264 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7265 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7266 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7267 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007268
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007269http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7270http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7271 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7272 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7273 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7274 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007275
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007276 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
7277 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7278 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007279 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007280 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7281 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7282 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007283 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007284 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007285
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02007286http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7287 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
7288 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
7289 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
7290
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007291http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
7292 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007293
7294 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
7295 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
7296 pointed by <resolvers>.
7297 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
7298 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
7299 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
7300 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
7301 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
7302 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
7303 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
7304 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
7305 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
7306 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02007307 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
7308 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007309
7310 Example:
7311 resolvers mydns
7312 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
7313 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
7314 timeout retry 1s
7315 hold valid 10s
7316 hold nx 3s
7317 hold other 3s
7318 hold obsolete 0s
7319 accepted_payload_size 8192
7320
7321 frontend fe
7322 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02007323 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007324 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
7325
7326 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
7327 # which mean DNS resolution error
7328 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
7329
7330 default_backend be
7331
7332 backend b_503
7333 # dummy backend used to return 503.
7334 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
7335 # 503 error page to end users
7336
7337 backend be
7338 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
7339 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
7340 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
7341 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
7342 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
7343
7344 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
7345 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
7346
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007347http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7348
7349 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
7350 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
7351 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
7352 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01007353 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
7354 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007355
7356 See RFC 8297 for more information.
7357
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007358http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007359http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007360http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007361http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007362http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007363http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007364http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007365http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7366http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007367
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007368 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
7369
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007370 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02007371 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
7372 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
7373 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
7374 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007375
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007376 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
7377 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
7378 the supported backend.
7379
7380 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
7381 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
7382 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
7383 number of segments in the path.
7384
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007385 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
7386 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
7387 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
7388 when improperly combined.
7389
7390 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
7391 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
7392 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
7393 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
7394 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
7395
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007396 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007397
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007398 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
7399
7400 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
7401 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
7402
7403 Example:
7404 - /#foo -> /%23foo
7405
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007406 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
7407
7408 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
7409 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
7410
7411 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
7412 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
7413
7414 Example:
7415 - /#foo -> /
7416
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007417 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
7418 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007419
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007420 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7421 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
7422
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02007423 Example:
7424 - /. -> /
7425 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
7426 - /a/./a -> /a/a
7427 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007428
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007429 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
7430 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
7431
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007432 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007433 their preceding segment.
7434
7435 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
7436 normalizer first if this is undesired.
7437
7438 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7439 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007440
7441 Example:
7442 - /foo/../ -> /
7443 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
7444 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
7445 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007446 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007447 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007448 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007449
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007450 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
7451 removed as well:
7452
7453 Example:
7454 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
7455 - /bar/../../ -> /
7456
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007457 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
7458 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007459
7460 Example:
7461 - // -> /
7462 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
7463
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007464 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
7465 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
7466
7467 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
7468 ".", "_", and "~".
7469
7470 Example:
7471 - /%61dmin -> /admin
7472 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
7473 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
7474 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
7475
7476 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7477 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7478
7479 Example:
7480 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
7481 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
7482
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007483 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02007484 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02007485
7486 Example:
7487 - /%6f -> /%6F
7488 - /%zz -> /%zz
7489
7490 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7491 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7492
7493 Example:
7494 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
7495
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007496 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02007497 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
7498 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
7499
7500 Example:
7501 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
7502 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
7503 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
7504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007505http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007507 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
7508 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
7509 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
7510 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
7511 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007513http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007514
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007515 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
7516 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
7517 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
7518 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007520http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7521 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007522
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007523 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007524 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
7525 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
7526 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
7527 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
7528 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02007529
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007530 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
7531 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
7532 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
7533 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
7534 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007535
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007536 Example:
7537 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
7538
7539 # applied to:
7540 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7541
7542 # outputs:
7543 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7544
7545 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007546
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007547 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
7548
7549 # applied to:
7550 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007551
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007552 # outputs:
7553 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007554
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007555http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7556 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7557
7558 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
7559 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02007560 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
7561 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
7562 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007563
7564 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7565 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7566 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7567
7568 Example:
7569 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7570 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7571
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007572 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7573 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7574 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7575 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7576
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007577http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7578 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7579
7580 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7581 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7582 query-string are replaced.
7583
7584 Example:
7585 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7586 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7587
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007588http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7589 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7590
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007591 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7592 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7593 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7594 against.
7595
7596 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7597 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7598 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007599
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007600 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7601 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7602 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7603 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7604 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7605 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7606 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7607 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7608 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007609 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7610 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007611
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007612 Example:
7613 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7614 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007615
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007616 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7617 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007619http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7620 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007621
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007622 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7623 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7624 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7625 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007626
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007627 Example:
7628 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007629
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007630 # applied to:
7631 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007632
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007633 # outputs:
7634 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007635
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007636http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7637 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7638 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01007639 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007640 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7641
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007642 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007643 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7644 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007645 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007646 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007647 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007648 are followed to create the response :
7649
7650 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7651 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7652 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7653 ignored.
7654
7655 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7656 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007657 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007658 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7659 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007660
7661 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7662 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7663 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007664 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007665 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007666
7667 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7668 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7669 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007670 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007671 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007672 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007673
7674 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7675 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7676 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7677 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7678 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7679 as a raw content.
7680
7681 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7682 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7683 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7684 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7685 considered as a raw string.
7686
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007687 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007688 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7689 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7690 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7691
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007692 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7693 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007694 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007695
7696 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7697
7698 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007699 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007700 if { path /ping }
7701
7702 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7703 if { path /favicon.ico }
7704
7705 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7706 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7707 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7708
Willy Tarreau5a72d032023-01-02 18:15:20 +01007709http-request sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7710 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7711
7712 This action increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
7713 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> by the value of
7714 either integer <int> or the integer evaluation of expression <expr>. Integers
7715 and expressions are limited to unsigned 32-bit values. If an error occurs,
7716 this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues. <idx> is an
7717 integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer between 0 and 2. It also
7718 silently fails if the there is no GPC stored at this index. The entry in the
7719 table is refreshed even if the value is zero. The 'gpc_rate' is automatically
7720 adjusted to reflect the average growth rate of the gpc value.
7721
7722 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7723 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7724 There is no equivalent function for legacy data types, but if the value is
7725 always 1, please see 'sc-inc-gpc()', 'sc-inc-gpc0()' and 'sc-inc-gpc1()'.
7726 There is no way to decrement the value either, but it is possible to store
7727 exact values in a General Purpose Tag using 'sc-set-gpt()' instead.
7728
7729 The main use of this action is to count scores or total volumes (e.g.
7730 estimated danger per source IP reported by the server or a WAF, total
7731 uploaded bytes, etc).
7732
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007733http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7734
7735 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7736 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7737 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7738 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7739 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7740 at this index.
7741 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7742 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007744http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7745http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007747 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7748 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7749 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007750
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007751http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7752 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7753 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7754 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7755 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7756 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7757 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7758 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7759 at this index.
7760 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7761 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7762
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007763http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7764 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007765
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007766 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7767 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7768 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7769 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007770
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007771http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7772 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7773
7774 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7775 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7776 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7777 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7778 agent name must be used.
7779
7780 Arguments:
7781 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7782
7783 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7784 configuration.
7785
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007786http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
7787 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007788
7789 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7790 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7791 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7792 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7793 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7794 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7795 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7796 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7797
7798 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7799 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7800 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7801
7802 Arguments:
7803 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7804 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7805 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7806 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7807
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007808 <size> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7809 bytes.
7810
7811 <time> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in
7812 milliseconds.
7813
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007814 Example:
7815 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7816 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7817
7818 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7819
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007820http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007821
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007822 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7823 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7824 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7825 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7826 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007827
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007828 Arguments:
7829 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7830 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007831
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007832 Example:
7833 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7834 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007835
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007836 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7837 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007839http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007840
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007841 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7842 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7843 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007844
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007845 Arguments:
7846 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7847 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007848
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007849 Example:
7850 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7851 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007852
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007853 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7854 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7855 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007856
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007857http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007858
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007859 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7860 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7861 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7862 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7863 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007864
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007865 Example:
7866 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7867 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7868 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7869 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7870 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7871 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7872 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7873 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7874 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007875
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007876http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007877
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007878 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7879 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7880 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7881 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7882 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007883
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007884http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7885 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007887 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7888 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7889 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7890 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7891 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7892 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7893 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7894 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7895 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007896
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007897http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007898
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007899 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7900 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7901 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7902 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7903 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7904 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7905 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007906 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7907 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007908
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007909http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007910
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007911 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7912 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7913 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007914
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007915http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007916
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007917 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7918 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7919 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7920 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7921 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7922 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7923 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7924 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007925
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007926http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007927
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007928 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7929 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7930 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7931 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7932 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7933 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007934
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007935 Example :
7936 # prepend the host name before the path
7937 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007938
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007939http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7940
7941 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7942 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7943 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007945http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007946
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007947 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7948 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7949 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7950 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7951 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007953http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007954
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007955 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7956 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7957 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7958 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7959 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7960 values have higher priority.
7961 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7962 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7963 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7964 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7965 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007966
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007967http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007968
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007969 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7970 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7971 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7972 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7973 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7974 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7975 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007976
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007977 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007978
7979 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007980 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7981 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007983http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7984 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7985 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7986 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007987 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7988 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007989
7990 Arguments :
7991 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7992 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007993
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007994 See also "option forwardfor".
7995
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007996 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007997 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7998 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7999
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02008000 # After the masking this will track connections
8001 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
8002 http-request track-sc0 src
8003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008004 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
8005 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
8006
8007http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8008
8009 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8010 expression.
8011
8012 Arguments:
8013 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
8014 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008015
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01008016 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008017 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
8018 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
8019
8020 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
8021 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
8022 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
8023
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02008024http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01008025 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8026
8027 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
8028 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
8029 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
8030 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
8031 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
8032
8033 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
8034 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
8035 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
8036 results.
8037
8038 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02008039 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
8040 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01008041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008042http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8043
8044 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
8045 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
8046 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
8047 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
8048 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
8049 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
8050 information from the request.
8051
8052 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
8053
8054http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8055
8056 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
8057 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01008058 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
8059 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
8060 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
8061 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
8062 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008063 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
8064
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008065http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8066http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008067
8068 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
8069 inline.
8070
8071 Arguments:
8072 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
8073 scope. The scopes allowed are:
8074 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
8075 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8076 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
8077 (request and response)
8078 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
8079 processing
8080 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8081 processing
8082 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8083 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8084 and '_'.
8085
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008086 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
8087 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05008088 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008089 conditions.
8090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008091 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8092 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01008093
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02008094 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
8095 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
8096
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008097 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008098 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02008099 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
8100
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008101http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008102
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008103 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
8104 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
8105 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
8106 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
8107 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
8108
8109 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
8110 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
8111 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
8112 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
8113 session tables.
8114
8115 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
8116 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
8117 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
8118 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
8119 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
8120 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
8121 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008122
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008123http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008124
8125 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
8126 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
8127 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
8128 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
8129 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05008130 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008131 processing.
8132
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01008133 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008134 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
8135 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
8136 rules evaluation.
8137
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008138http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8139http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8140 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8141 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8142 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8143 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008144
8145 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
8146 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
8147 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008148 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
8149 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
8150 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
8151 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
8152 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
8153 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008154 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008155 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
8156 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
8157 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008158 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008159 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
8160 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
8161 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
8162 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8163 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008164
8165http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8166http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8167http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8168
8169 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
8170 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01008171 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set by the
8172 global "tune.stick-counters" setting, which defaults to MAX_SESS_STKCTR if
8173 set at build time (it is reported in haproxy -vv) and which defaults to 3,
8174 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (tune.stick-counters-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008175 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8176 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
8177 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
8178 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8179 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
8180 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
8181 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
8182
8183 Arguments :
8184 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
8185 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
8186 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
8187 select which table entry to update the counters.
8188
8189 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
8190 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
8191 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
8192 that table until the session ends.
8193
8194 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
8195 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
8196 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
8197 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
8198 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
8199 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
8200 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
8201 useful information.
8202
8203 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
8204 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
8205 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
8206 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
8207 checks that make use of it.
8208
8209http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8210
8211 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008212
8213 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008214 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008215
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01008216http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8217
8218 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
8219 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
8220 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
8221 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
8222 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
8223 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8224
8225 Arguments :
8226 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
8227
8228 Example:
8229 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
8230
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008231http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8232 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8233
Thayne McCombs77f35912024-01-28 22:07:32 -07008234 This will delay the processing of the request or response until one of the
8235 following conditions occurs:
8236 - The full request body is received, in which case processing proceeds
8237 normally.
8238 - <bytes> bytes have been received, when the "at-least" argument is given and
8239 <bytes> is non-zero, in which case processing proceeds normally.
8240 - The request buffer is full, in which case processing proceeds normally. The
8241 size of this buffer is determined by the "tune.bufsize" option.
8242 - The request has been waiting for more than <time> milliseconds. In this
8243 case HAProxy will respond with a 408 "Request Timeout" error to the client
8244 and stop processing the request. Note that if any of the other conditions
8245 happens first, this timeout will not occur even if the full body has
8246 not yet been recieved.
8247
8248 This action may be used as a replacement for "option http-buffer-request".
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008249
8250 Arguments :
8251
8252 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
8253 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
8254
8255 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05008256 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Thayne McCombs77f35912024-01-28 22:07:32 -07008257 bytes. A value of 0 (the default) means no limit.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008258
8259 Example:
8260 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
8261
8262 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008264http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008265
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008266 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
8267 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
8268 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008269
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01008270
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008271http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008272 Access control for Layer 7 responses
8273
8274 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008275 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008276
8277 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
8278 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
8279 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
8280 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
8281 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
8282 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
8283
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008284 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
8285 supported:
8286 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8287 - add-header <name> <fmt>
8288 - allow
8289 - cache-store <name>
8290 - capture <sample> id <id>
8291 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8292 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
8293 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8294 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
8295 - redirect <rule>
8296 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8297 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8298 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008299 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008300 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
8301 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
8302 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
8303 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8304 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8305 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008306 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008307 - set-header <name> <fmt>
8308 - set-log-level <level>
8309 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8310 - set-mark <mark>
8311 - set-nice <nice>
8312 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8313 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008314 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
8315 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +01008316 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008317 - strict-mode { on | off }
8318 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
8319 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
8320 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
8321 - unset-var(<var-name>)
8322 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8323
8324 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008325
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008326 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008327
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008328 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
8329 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
8330 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
8331 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
8332 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
8333 a defaults section defining such rules.
8334
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008335 Example:
8336 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02008337
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008338 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008339
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008340 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
8341 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008342
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008343 Example:
8344 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008345
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008346 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008347
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008348 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
8349 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008350
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008351 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8352 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008353
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008354http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008355
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008356 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8357 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008358
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008359http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008360
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008361 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008362 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
8363 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008364
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008365http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008366
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008367 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
8368 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008369
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02008370http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008371
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008372 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008373
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008374http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008375
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008376 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
8377 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
8378 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
8379 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
8380 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
8381 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
8382 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008383
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008384 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
8385 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
8386 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
8387 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
8388 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01008389
8390 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
8391 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
8392 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
8393 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008394
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008395http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008396
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008397 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8398 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02008399
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00008400http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02008401
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008402 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
8403 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02008404
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008405http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02008406
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008407 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8408 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008409
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008410http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8411http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8412 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8413 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8414 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8415 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008416
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008417 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
8418 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
8419 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008420 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008421 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
8422 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
8423 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01008424 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008425 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008426
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008427http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008429 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
8430 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
8431 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
8432 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
8433 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
8434 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008435
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008436http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8437 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008438
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008439 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
8440 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01008441
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008442 Example:
8443 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02008444
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008445 # applied to:
8446 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008447
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008448 # outputs:
8449 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008450
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008451 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008452
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008453http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8454 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008455
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01008456 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008457 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008458
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008459 Example:
8460 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008461
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008462 # applied to:
8463 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008464
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008465 # outputs:
8466 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008467
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008468http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
8469 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8470 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01008471 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008472 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8473
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008474 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
8475 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
8476 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008477
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008478http-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8479 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8480
8481 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
8482 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
8483 a complete description.
8484
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02008485http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008486http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8487http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08008488
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008489 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
8490 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
8491 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
8492 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008493
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02008494http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008495 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01008496http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8497 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008498
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008499 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
8500 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02008501 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008502
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02008503http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
8504 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008505
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008506 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
8507 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02008508
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008509http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
8510 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02008511
8512 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
8513 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
8514 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
8515
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008516http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008517
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008518 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
8519 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
8520 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
8521 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008522
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008523http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8524
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008525 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
8526 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008527
8528http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8529
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008530 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8531 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008532
8533http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8534
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008535 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
8536 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
8537 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008538
8539http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8540
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008541 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
8542 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008543
8544http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8545 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8546
8547 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
8548 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
8549 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
8550 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008551
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008552 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008553 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
8554 http-response set-status 431
8555 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
8556 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008557
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008558http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008559
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008560 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008561 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
8562 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008563
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008564http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8565http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008566
8567 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008568 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
8569 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008570
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008571http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008572
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008573 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
8574 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008575 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
8576 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008577
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008578http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008579
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008580 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
8581 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008582
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008583http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8584http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8585http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008586
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008587 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
8588 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
8589 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008590
8591http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8592
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008593 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008594 about <var-name>.
8595
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008596http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8597 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8598
8599 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008600 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
8601 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008602
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02008603
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008604http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
8605 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
8606
8607 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8608 yes | no | yes | yes
8609
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008610 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008611 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
8612 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
8613 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008614
8615 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8616
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008617 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8618 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8619 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8620 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8621 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8622 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8623 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008624 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008625 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8626 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008627
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008628 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8629 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8630 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8631 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8632 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8633 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8634 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008635 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8636 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8637 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8638 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8639 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8640 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008641
8642 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8643 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8644 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8645 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8646 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8647 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8648 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8649 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008650 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008651 downsides of rare connection failures.
8652
8653 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8654 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8655 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8656 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8657 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8658 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008659 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008660 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8661 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8662 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8663 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8664 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8665
8666 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008667 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8668 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8669 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8670 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008671
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008672 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
Amaury Denoyelleab6b0742024-03-20 09:25:03 +01008673 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private if possible and never shared.
8674 This won't be the case however when using a protocol with multiplexing
8675 abilities and using reuse mode level value greater than the default "safe"
8676 strategy as in this case nothing prevents the connection from being already
8677 shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008678
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008679 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008680
8681 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8682 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8683 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8684
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008685 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8686 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8687 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8688 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8689 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8690 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8691 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8692 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8693 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8694 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8695 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8696
8697 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8698 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8699 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8700 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8701 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8702
8703 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8704 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008705
8706
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008707http-send-name-header [<header>]
8708 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008709 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8710 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008711 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008712 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8713
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008714 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8715 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8716 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8717 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8718 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8719 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8720 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8721 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8722 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8723 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8724 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8725 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8726 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8727 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8728 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8729 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008730
8731 See also : "server"
8732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008733id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008734 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8736 no | yes | yes | yes
8737 Arguments : none
8738
8739 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8740 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8741 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008742
8743
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008744ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8745 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8746 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008747 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008748
8749 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8750 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8751 and running).
8752
8753 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8754 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8755 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008756 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008757 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8758
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008759 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8760 "unless" condition is met.
8761
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008762 Example:
8763 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8764 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8765 ignore-persist if url_static
8766
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008767 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8768
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008769load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8770 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8771 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8772 yes | no | yes | yes
8773
8774 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8775 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8776 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008777 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008778 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008779 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8780 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8781 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8782
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008783 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008784 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008785 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008786
8787 Arguments:
8788 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8789 named "server-state-file".
8790
8791 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8792 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8793 name is used as a file name.
8794
8795 none don't load any stat for this backend
8796
8797 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008798 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8799 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8800 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008801 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008802 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008803
8804 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8805 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8806
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008807 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008808
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008809 global
8810 stats socket /tmp/socket
8811 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008812
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008813 defaults
8814 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008815
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008816 backend bk
8817 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8818 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008819
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008820
8821 Then one can run :
8822
8823 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8824
8825 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8826
8827 1
8828 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8829 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8830 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8831
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008832 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008833
8834 global
8835 stats socket /tmp/socket
8836 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8837
8838 defaults
8839 load-server-state-from-file local
8840
8841 backend bk
8842 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8843 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8844
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008845
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008846 Then one can run :
8847
8848 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8849
8850 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8851
8852 1
8853 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8854 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8855 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8856
8857 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8858 "show servers state"
8859
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008860
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008861log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008862log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008863 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008864no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008865 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8867 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008868
8869 Prefix :
8870 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8871 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8872 prefix does not allow arguments.
8873
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008874 Arguments :
8875 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8876 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8877 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8878 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8879 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8880 parameter.
8881
8882 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8883 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8884
8885 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8886 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8887 standard syslog port).
8888
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008889 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8890 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8891 standard syslog port).
8892
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008893 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8894 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8895 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008896 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008897
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008898 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8899 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8900 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8901 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8902 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8903 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8904 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8905 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8906 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8907 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8908 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8909 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008910 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008911 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8912 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8913 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008914 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8915 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008916
8917 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8918 and "fd@2", see above.
8919
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008920 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8921 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8922 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8923 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8924 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8925 having the logs instantly available.
8926
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008927 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8928 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8929 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8930
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008931 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8932 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008933
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008934 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8935 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8936 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8937 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8938 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8939 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8940 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8941 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8942 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8943 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008944 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008945
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008946 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8947 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8948 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8949 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8950 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8951
8952 <sample_size>
8953 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8954 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8955 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8956 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8957 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8958
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008959 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8960 one of the following :
8961
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008962 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8963 field is stripped. This is the default.
8964 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8965 rfc3164.
8966
8967 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008968 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8969
8970 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8971 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8972
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008973 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8974 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8975 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8976 designed to be used with a local log server.
8977
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008978 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8979 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8980 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8981 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8982 systemd logger consumes.
8983
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008984 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8985 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8986 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8987 used with a local log server.
8988
8989 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8990 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8991 designed to be used with a local log server.
8992
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008993 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8994 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8995 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8996 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8997
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008998 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8999
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01009000 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
9001 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
9002 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
9003
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01009004 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
9005 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
9006 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
9007 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009008
9009 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
9010 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
9011 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02009012 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
9013 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
9014 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
9015 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
9016 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009017
9018 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
9019
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02009020 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
9021 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
9022 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009023
9024 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
9025 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
9026 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
9027 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
9028
9029 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
9030 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009031
9032 Example :
9033 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01009034 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
9035 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
9036 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02009037 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02009038 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
9039 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009040 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01009041
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009042
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009043log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01009044 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
9045 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9046 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009047
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01009048 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
9049 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
9050 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02009051 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.6 which covers the custom log
9052 format string in depth.
9053
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02009054 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
9055 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009056
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009057 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
9058 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009059
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02009060log-format-sd <string>
9061 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
9062 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9063 yes | yes | yes | no
9064
9065 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
9066 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
9067 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02009068 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.6
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02009069 which covers the log format string in depth.
9070
9071 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
9072 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
9073
9074 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
9075 log format to "rfc5424".
9076
9077 Example :
9078 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
9079
9080
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01009081log-tag <string>
9082 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
9083 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9084 yes | yes | yes | yes
9085
9086 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
9087 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009088 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01009089 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
9090 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
9091 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
9092 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
9093 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
9094 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009095
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009096max-keep-alive-queue <value>
9097 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
9098 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9099 yes | no | yes | yes
9100
9101 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
9102 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
9103 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
9104 servers.
9105
9106 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009107 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009108 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
9109 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
9110 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009111 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009112 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
9113 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
9114 picking a different server.
9115
9116 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
9117 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
9118 even if they have to be queued.
9119
9120 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
9121 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
9122
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01009123max-session-srv-conns <nb>
9124 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
9125 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
9126 defined at build time).
Aurelien DARRAGON04445cf2023-11-20 17:53:36 +01009127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9128 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009129
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009130maxconn <conns>
9131 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
9132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9133 yes | yes | yes | no
9134 Arguments :
9135 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
9136 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
9137 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
9138 closes.
9139
9140 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009141 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009142 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
9143 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01009144 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
9145 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
9146 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
9147 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009148
9149 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
9150 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
9151 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
9152
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01009153 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
9154 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02009155
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009156 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
9157
9158
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02009159mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009160 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
9161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9162 yes | yes | yes | yes
9163 Arguments :
9164 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
9165 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
9166 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
9167 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
9168
9169 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
9170 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
9171 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
9172 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
9173 brings HAProxy most of its value.
9174
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009175 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
9176 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
9177 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009178
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009179 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009180 defaults http_instances
9181 mode http
9182
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009183
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009184monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009185 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9187 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009188 Arguments :
9189 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
9190 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009191 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009192 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
9193 backend and its backup.
9194
9195 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
9196 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
9197 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
9198 servers in a list of backends.
9199
9200 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
9201 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
9202 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009203 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009204 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
9205 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009206 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02009207 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
9208 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009209
9210 Example:
9211 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009212 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009213 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9214 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9215 monitor-uri /site_alive
9216 monitor fail if site_dead
9217
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009218 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009219
9220
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009221monitor-uri <uri>
9222 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
9223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9224 yes | yes | yes | no
9225 Arguments :
9226 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
9227 health status instead of forwarding the request.
9228
9229 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
9230 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
9231 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
9232 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
9233 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
9234 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
9235 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
9236 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
9237
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01009238 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009239 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
9240 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01009241 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
9242 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
9243 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009244 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
9245 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
9246 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009247
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01009248 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
9249 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
9250 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
9251 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
9252
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009253 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009254 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009255 frontend www
9256 mode http
9257 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
9258
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009259 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009261
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009262option abortonclose
9263no option abortonclose
9264 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
9265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9266 yes | no | yes | yes
9267 Arguments : none
9268
9269 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
9270 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
9271 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
9272 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009273 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009274 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
9275 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
9276 encountered while delivering the response.
9277
9278 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
9279 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
9280 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
9281 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
9282 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
9283 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009284 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009285 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009286 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009287 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
9288 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
9289 still not served and not pollute the servers.
9290
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009291 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
9292 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009293 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
9294 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
9295 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
9296 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
9297 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
9298 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009299 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009300
9301 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9302 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9303
9304 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
9305
9306
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009307option accept-invalid-http-request
9308no option accept-invalid-http-request
9309 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
9310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9311 yes | yes | yes | no
9312 Arguments : none
9313
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009314 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009315 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009316 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009317 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9318 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9319 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9320 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9321 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009322 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
9323 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
9324 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
9325 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009326 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009327 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02009328 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02009329 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
9330 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +02009331 Finally, this option also allows incoming URLs to contain fragment references
9332 ('#' after the path).
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009333
9334 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9335 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9336 been confirmed.
9337
9338 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9339 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009340 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
9341 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009342 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9343
9344 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9345 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9346
9347 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
9348 stats socket.
9349
9350
9351option accept-invalid-http-response
9352no option accept-invalid-http-response
9353 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
9354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9355 yes | no | yes | yes
9356 Arguments : none
9357
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009358 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009359 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009360 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009361 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9362 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9363 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9364 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9365 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009366 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
9367 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
9368 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009369
9370 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9371 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9372 been confirmed.
9373
9374 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9375 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
9376 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
9377 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9378
9379 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9380 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9381
9382 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
9383 stats socket.
9384
9385
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009386option allbackups
9387no option allbackups
9388 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
9389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9390 yes | no | yes | yes
9391 Arguments : none
9392
9393 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
9394 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
9395 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
9396 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
9397 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
9398 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
9399 order between the backup servers anymore.
9400
9401 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
9402 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
9403
9404 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9405 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9406
9407
9408option checkcache
9409no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08009410 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9412 yes | no | yes | yes
9413 Arguments : none
9414
9415 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
9416 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009417 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009418 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
9419 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009420 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009421
9422 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009423 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009424 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009425 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
9426 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009427 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009428 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01009429 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
9430 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009431 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01009432 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
9433 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009434 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009435 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
9436 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
9437 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
9438 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
9439 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
9440 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
9441 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
9442 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
9443 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
9444
9445 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009446 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
9447 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
9448 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
9449 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009450
9451 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
9452 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009453 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009454 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009455
9456 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9457 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9458
9459
9460option clitcpka
9461no option clitcpka
9462 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
9463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9464 yes | yes | yes | no
9465 Arguments : none
9466
9467 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9468 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009469 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009470 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9471
9472 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9473 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9474 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9475 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9476
9477 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9478 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9479 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9480 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9481 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9482
9483 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9484
9485 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9486 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9487 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
9488
9489 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9490 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9491
9492 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
9493
9494
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009495option contstats
9496 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
9497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9498 yes | yes | yes | no
9499 Arguments : none
9500
9501 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
9502 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
9503 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009504 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01009505 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
9506 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
9507 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
9508 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
9509 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009510
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009511option disable-h2-upgrade
9512no option disable-h2-upgrade
9513 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
9514 connection.
9515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9516 yes | yes | yes | no
9517 Arguments : none
9518
9519 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
9520 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
9521 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
9522 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01009523 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
9524 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
9525 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
9526 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
9527 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
9528 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009529
9530 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9531 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009532
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009533option dontlog-normal
9534no option dontlog-normal
9535 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
9536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9537 yes | yes | yes | no
9538 Arguments : none
9539
9540 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
9541 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
9542 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
9543 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
9544 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
9545 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
9546 logged.
9547
9548 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
9549 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
9550 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
9551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009552 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009553 logging.
9554
9555
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009556option dontlognull
9557no option dontlognull
9558 Enable or disable logging of null connections
9559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9560 yes | yes | yes | no
9561 Arguments : none
9562
9563 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
9564 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
9565 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
9566 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
9567 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
9568 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009569 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
9570 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
9571 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009572
9573 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009574 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009575 would not be logged.
9576
9577 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9578 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9579
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009580 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009581 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009582
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009583option forwarded [ proto ]
9584 [ host | host-expr <host_expr> ]
9585 [ by | by-expr <by_expr> ] [ by_port | by_port-expr <by_port_expr>]
9586 [ for | for-expr <for_expr> ] [ for_port | for_port-expr <for_port_expr>]
9587no option forwarded
9588 Enable insertion of the rfc 7239 forwarded header in requests sent to servers
9589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9590 yes | no | yes | yes
9591 Arguments :
9592 <host_expr> optional argument to specify a custom sample expression
9593 those result will be used as 'host' parameter value
9594
9595 <by_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9596 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodename value
9597
9598 <for_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9599 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodename value
9600
9601 <by_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9602 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodeport value
9603
9604 <for_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9605 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodeport value
9606
9607
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009608 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, servers are losing some request
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009609 context (request origin: client ip address, protocol used...)
9610
9611 A common way to address this limitation is to use the well known
9612 x-forward-for and x-forward-* friends to expose some of this context to the
9613 underlying servers/applications.
9614 While this use to work and is widely deployed, it is not officially supported
9615 by the IETF and can be the root of some interoperability as well as security
9616 issues.
9617
9618 To solve this, a new HTTP extension has been described by the IETF:
9619 forwarded header (RFC7239).
9620 More information here: https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html
9621
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009622 The use of this single header allow to convey numerous details
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009623 within the same header, and most importantly, fixes the proxy chaining
9624 issue. (the rfc allows for multiple chained proxies to append their own
9625 values to an already existing header).
9626
9627 This option may be specified in defaults, listen or backend section, but it
9628 will be ignored for frontend sections.
9629
9630 Setting option forwarded without arguments results in using default implicit
9631 behavior.
9632 Default behavior enables proto parameter and injects original client ip.
9633
9634 The equivalent explicit/manual configuration would be:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01009635 option forwarded proto for
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009636
9637 The keyword 'by' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9638 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9639 'by' value will be set to proxy ip (destination address)
9640 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'by' will be set to
9641 "unknown".
9642
9643 The keyword 'by-expr' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9644 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9645 'by' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9646 <by_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9647
9648 The keyword 'for' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9649 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9650 'for' value will be set to client ip (source address)
9651 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'for' will be set to
9652 "unknown".
9653
9654 The keyword 'for-expr' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9655 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9656 'for' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9657 <for_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9658
9659 The keyword 'by_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9660 'by' parameter. 'by_port' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9661 it will be ignored.
9662 "nodeport" will be set to proxy (destination) port if available,
9663 otherwise it will be ignored.
9664
9665 The keyword 'by_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9666 'by' parameter. 'by_port-expr' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9667 it will be ignored.
9668 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9669 <by_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9670
9671 The keyword 'for_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9672 'for' parameter. 'for_port' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9673 it will be ignored.
9674 "nodeport" will be set to client (source) port if available,
9675 otherwise it will be ignored.
9676
9677 The keyword 'for_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9678 'for' parameter. 'for_port-expr' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9679 it will be ignored.
9680 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9681 <for_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9682
9683 Examples :
9684 # Those servers want the ip address and protocol of the client request
9685 # Resulting header would look like this:
9686 # forwarded: proto=http;for=127.0.0.1
9687 backend www_default
9688 mode http
9689 option forwarded
9690 #equivalent to: option forwarded proto for
9691
9692 # Those servers want the requested host and hashed client ip address
9693 # as well as client source port (you should use seed for xxh32 if ensuring
9694 # ip privacy is a concern)
9695 # Resulting header would look like this:
9696 # forwarded: host="haproxy.org";for="_000000007F2F367E:60138"
9697 backend www_host
9698 mode http
9699 option forwarded host for-expr src,xxh32,hex for_port
9700
9701 # Those servers want custom data in host, for and by parameters
9702 # Resulting header would look like this:
9703 # forwarded: host="host.com";by=_haproxy;for="[::1]:10"
9704 backend www_custom
9705 mode http
9706 option forwarded host-expr str(host.com) by-expr str(_haproxy) for for_port-expr int(10)
9707
9708 # Those servers want random 'for' obfuscated identifiers for request
9709 # tracing purposes while protecting sensitive IP information
9710 # Resulting header would look like this:
9711 # forwarded: for=_000000002B1F4D63
9712 backend www_for_hide
9713 mode http
9714 option forwarded for-expr rand,hex
9715
9716 See also : "option forwardfor", "option originalto"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009717
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009718option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009719 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
9720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9721 yes | yes | yes | yes
9722 Arguments :
9723 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9724 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009725 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009726 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009727
9728 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
9729 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
9730 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
9731 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
9732 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
9733 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
9734 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009735 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
9736 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9737 possible that the client has already brought one.
9738
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009739 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009740 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009741 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009742 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009743 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009744 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009745
9746 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9747 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9748 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
9749 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
9750 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
9751 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01009752 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009753
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009754 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
9755 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009756 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009757 are under the control of the end-user.
9758
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009759 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009760 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9761 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009762 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9763 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9764 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009765
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009766 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009767 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9768 frontend www
9769 mode http
9770 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9771
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009772 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9773 backend www
9774 mode http
9775 option forwardfor header X-Client
9776
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009777 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009778 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009779
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009780
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009781option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9782no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9783 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9785 yes | yes | yes | no
9786 Arguments : none
9787
9788 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9789 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9790 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9791 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9792 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9793 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9794 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9795
9796 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9797 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9798 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9799 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9800 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9801 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9802 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9803 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9804 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9805 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9806
9807 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9808
9809 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9810 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9811
9812 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9813 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9814
9815
9816option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9817no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9818 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9820 yes | no | yes | yes
9821 Arguments : none
9822
9823 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9824 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9825 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9826 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9827 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9828 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9829 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9830
9831 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9832 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9833 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9834 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9835 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9836 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9837 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9838 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9839 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9840 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9841
9842 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9843
9844 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9845 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9846
9847 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9848 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9849
9850
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009851option http-buffer-request
9852no option http-buffer-request
9853 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9855 yes | yes | yes | yes
9856 Arguments : none
9857
9858 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9859 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9860 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9861 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9862 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9863 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009864 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9865 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9866 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9867 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009868
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009869 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9870 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009871
9872
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009873option http-ignore-probes
9874no option http-ignore-probes
9875 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9877 yes | yes | yes | no
9878 Arguments : none
9879
9880 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9881 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9882 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9883 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9884 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9885 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9886 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9887 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9888 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009889 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9890 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009891 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9892
9893 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9894 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9895 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9896 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9897 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9898 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9899 are often the only way to detect them.
9900
9901 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9902 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9903
9904 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9905
9906
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009907option http-keep-alive
9908no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009909 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
9910 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9912 yes | yes | yes | yes
9913 Arguments : none
9914
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009915 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009916 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9917 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9918 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9919 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
9920 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009921
9922 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9923 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009924 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9925 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9926 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9927 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9928 situations where this option may be useful :
9929
9930 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009931 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009932
9933 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9934 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9935
9936 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009937
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009938 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9939 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9940 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9941 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9942 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9943 not set.
9944
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009945 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009946 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009947
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009948 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009949 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009950
9951
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009952option http-no-delay
9953no option http-no-delay
9954 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9956 yes | yes | yes | yes
9957 Arguments : none
9958
9959 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9960 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9961 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9962 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9963 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9964 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9965 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009966 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009967 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9968 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9969 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9970 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9971 affected.
9972
9973 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9974 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9975 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9976 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9977 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9978 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9979 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9980 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9981 latency environments.
9982
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009983 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9984
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009985
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009986option http-pretend-keepalive
9987no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009988 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
9989 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009991 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009992 Arguments : none
9993
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009994 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009995 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
9996 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
9997 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
9998 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
9999 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
10000 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +020010001
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010002 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +020010003 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010004 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +020010005 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010006 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +020010007 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
10008
10009 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
10010 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
10011 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
10012 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010013 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
10014 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +020010015 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
10016
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +020010017 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
10018 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
10019 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010020 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +020010021
10022 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10023 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10024
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010025 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +010010026 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +020010027
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +020010028option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
10029 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
10030 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
10031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10032 yes | yes | yes | yes
10033 Arguments :
10034 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
10035 with no FastCGI application configured.
10036
10037 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
10038 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
10039 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
10040
10041 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
10042 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
10043
10044 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
10045 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
10046 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
10047 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
10048 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
10049 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
10050 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
10051 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
10052
10053 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
10054 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010055
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010056option http-server-close
10057no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010058 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10060 yes | yes | yes | yes
10061 Arguments : none
10062
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010063 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010064 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
10065 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
10066 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
10067 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
10068 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
10069 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
10070 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
10071 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
10072 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
10073 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
10074 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
10075 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
10076 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010077
10078 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
10079 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
10080 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
10081 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010082 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
10083 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010084
10085 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
10086 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +020010087 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
10088 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
10089 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010090
10091 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10092 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10093
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010094 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
10095 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010096
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010097option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010098no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010099 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
10100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10101 yes | yes | yes | no
10102 Arguments : none
10103
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000010104 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010105 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
10106 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
10107 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
10108 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
10109 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010110 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010111
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010112 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010113 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +010010114 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
10115 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
10116 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010117
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +010010118 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
10119 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
10120 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
10121 front of an existing proxy.
10122
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010123 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
10124
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010125 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010126
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010127option httpchk
10128option httpchk <uri>
10129option httpchk <method> <uri>
10130option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010131 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10133 yes | no | yes | yes
10134 Arguments :
10135 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
10136 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
10137 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
10138 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
10139 ones.
10140
10141 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
10142 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
10143 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
10144
10145 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
10146 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
10147 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +020010148 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010149
10150 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
10151 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
10152 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
10153 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
10154 the lack of any response.
10155
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010156 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
10157 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
10158 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
10159 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
10160
10161 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
10162 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
10163 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010164
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010165 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
10166 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010167 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010168 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010169 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010170
10171 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010172 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
10173 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
10174 backend https_relay
10175 mode tcp
10176 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
10177 http-check send hdr Host www
10178 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010179
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010180 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
10181 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
10182 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010183
10184
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010185option httpclose
10186no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010187 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10189 yes | yes | yes | yes
10190 Arguments : none
10191
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010192 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010193 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
10194 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
10195 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
10196 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010197
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010198 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
Christopher Fauletd17dd842023-02-20 17:30:06 +010010199 connection, depending where the option is set. The frontend is considered for
10200 client connections while the backend is considered for server ones. If the
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010201 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
10202 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
10203 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010205 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010206 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
10207 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010208
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +020010209 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010210 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010211
10212 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10213 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10214
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010215 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010216
10217
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010218option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010219 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
10220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010221 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010222 Arguments :
10223 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
10224 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
10225 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010226 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010227 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010228
10229 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10230 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10231 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10232 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10233 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10234 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
10235 ports.
10236
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +010010237 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
10238 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010239
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010240 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010242 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010243
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020010244option httpslog
10245 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
10246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10247 yes | yes | yes | no
10248
10249 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10250 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10251 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10252 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10253 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10254 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
10255 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
10256
10257 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10258
10259 See also : section 8 about logging.
10260
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010261
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010262option independent-streams
10263no option independent-streams
10264 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10266 yes | yes | yes | yes
10267 Arguments : none
10268
10269 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
10270 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
10271 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
10272 receive data or not.
10273
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010274 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010275 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
10276 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
10277 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
10278 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
10279 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
10280 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
10281 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
10282 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
10283 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
10284 socket buffers.
10285
10286 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
10287 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
10288 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
10289 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
10290 slow lines, so use it with caution.
10291
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010292 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010293
10294
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +020010295option ldap-check
10296 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
10297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10298 yes | no | yes | yes
10299 Arguments : none
10300
10301 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
10302 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
10303 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
10304 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
10305
10306 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
10307 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
10308
10309 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
10310 configure it.
10311
10312 Example :
10313 option ldap-check
10314
10315 See also : "option httpchk"
10316
10317
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010318option external-check
10319 Use external processes for server health checks
10320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10321 yes | no | yes | yes
10322
10323 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
10324 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
10325 command".
10326
10327 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
10328
10329 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
10330
10331
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +010010332option idle-close-on-response
10333no option idle-close-on-response
10334 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
10335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10336 yes | yes | yes | no
10337 Arguments : none
10338
10339 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
10340 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
10341 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
10342 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
10343 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
10344 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
10345 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
10346 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
10347 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
10348
10349 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
10350 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
10351
10352 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
10353 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
10354 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
10355 needed in case of frequent reloads.
10356
10357 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
10358 "hard-stop-after"
10359
10360
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010361option log-health-checks
10362no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010363 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10365 yes | no | yes | yes
10366 Arguments : none
10367
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010368 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
10369 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
10370 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010371
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010372 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
10373 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
10374 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
10375 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
10376 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
10377
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010378 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010379 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010380
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010381 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
10382 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
10383 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010384
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010385
10386option log-separate-errors
10387no option log-separate-errors
10388 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
10389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10390 yes | yes | yes | no
10391 Arguments : none
10392
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010393 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010394 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
10395 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
10396 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
10397 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
10398 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
10399 provides very important information.
10400
10401 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
10402 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
10403 error logs.
10404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010405 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010406 logging.
10407
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010408
10409option logasap
10410no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010411 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10413 yes | yes | yes | no
10414 Arguments : none
10415
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010416 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
10417 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
10418 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
10419 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
10420
10421 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
10422 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
10423 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
10424 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
10425 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010426 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010427 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
10428 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
10429 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
10430 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010431 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010432
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010433 Examples :
10434 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
10435 mode http
10436 option httplog
10437 option logasap
10438 log 192.168.2.200 local3
10439
10440 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10441 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10442 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
10443 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010445 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010446 logging.
10447
10448
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010449option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010450 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10452 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010453 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010454 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
10455 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010456 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
10457 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010458
10459 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
10460 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010461 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010462 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010463 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
10464 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
10465 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010466
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010467 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
10468 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
10469 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010470
10471 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010472 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010473 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
10474 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
10475 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
10476 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
10477 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
10478 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
10479 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
10480
10481 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
10482 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010483
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +020010484 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010485
10486 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
10487 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
10488 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10489 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010490 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010491 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010492
10493 See also: "option httpchk"
10494
10495
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010496option nolinger
10497no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010498 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010499 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10500 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010501 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010502
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010503 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010504 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
10505 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
10506 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
10507 connections.
10508
10509 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
10510 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010511 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
10512 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
10513 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
10514 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
10515 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
10516 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
10517 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
10518 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
10519 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
10520 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
10521 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
10522 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
10523 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010524
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010525 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
10526 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
10527 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
10528 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
10529 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010530
10531 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
10532 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010533 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050010534 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010535 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010536
10537 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10538 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10539
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010540 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
10541 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010542
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010543option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
10544 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
10545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10546 yes | yes | yes | yes
10547 Arguments :
10548 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
10549 matching <network>
10550 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
10551 header name.
10552
10553 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
10554 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
10555 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
10556 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
10557 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
10558 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
10559 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
10560 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
10561 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
10562 possible that the client has already brought one.
10563
10564 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
10565 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
10566 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
10567 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
10568 header and requires different one.
10569
10570 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
10571 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
10572 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +010010573 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
10574 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
10575 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
10576 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
10577 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010578
10579 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
10580 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
10581 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
10582 both are defined.
10583
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010584 Examples :
10585 # Original Destination address
10586 frontend www
10587 mode http
10588 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
10589
10590 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
10591 backend www
10592 mode http
10593 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
10594
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010595 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010596
10597
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010598option persist
10599no option persist
10600 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
10601 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10602 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010603 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010604
10605 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
10606 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
10607 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
10608 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
10609 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
10610 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
10611 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
10612 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
10613 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
10614 redirected to another valid server.
10615
10616 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10617 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10618
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +010010619 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010620
10621
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +020010622option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +010010623 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
10624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10625 yes | no | yes | yes
10626 Arguments :
10627 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
10628 PostgreSQL server.
10629
10630 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
10631 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
10632 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
10633 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
10634
10635 See also: "option httpchk"
10636
10637
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010638option prefer-last-server
10639no option prefer-last-server
10640 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
10641 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10642 yes | no | yes | yes
10643 Arguments : none
10644
10645 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010646 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010647 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
10648 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010649 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010650 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010651 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010652 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
10653 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010654 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010655 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +020010656 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
10657 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
10658 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010659 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
10660 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
10661 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010662
10663 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10664 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10665
10666 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
10667
10668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010669option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010670option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010671no option redispatch
10672 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
10673 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10674 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010675 Arguments :
10676 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
10677 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
10678 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010679 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010680 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010681 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010682 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
10683 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
10684 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
10685
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010686
10687 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
10688 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
10689 be able to access the service anymore.
10690
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +010010691 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
10692 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010693
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +020010694 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
10695 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
10696 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
10697 following order:
10698
10699 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
10700
10701 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
10702 list, or
10703
10704 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
10705
10706 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
10707 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
10708
10709 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
10710 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
10711 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
10712 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
10713
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010714 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010715 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
10716 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010717
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010718 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10719 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10720
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010721 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010722
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010723
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010724option redis-check
10725 Use redis health checks for server testing
10726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10727 yes | no | yes | yes
10728 Arguments : none
10729
10730 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
10731 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10732 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
10733 find the "+PONG" response message.
10734
10735 Example :
10736 option redis-check
10737
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010738 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010739
10740
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010741option smtpchk
10742option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10743 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10745 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010746 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010747 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010748 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010749 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10750
10751 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10752 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10753 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10754
10755 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10756 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10757 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10758 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10759 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10760 dead server.
10761
10762 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10763 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010764 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010765 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10766
10767 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10768 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10769 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10770 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010771 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010772
10773 Example :
10774 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10775
10776 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10777
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010779option socket-stats
10780no option socket-stats
10781
10782 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10784 yes | yes | yes | no
10785
10786 Arguments : none
10787
10788
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010789option splice-auto
10790no option splice-auto
10791 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10793 yes | yes | yes | yes
10794 Arguments : none
10795
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010796 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010797 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010798 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010799 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010800 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010801 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10802 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10803 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10804 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10805
10806 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10807 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10808 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10809 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10810 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10811 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10812 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10813 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10814 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10815 keyword.
10816
10817 Example :
10818 option splice-auto
10819
10820 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10821 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10822
10823 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10824 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10825
10826
10827option splice-request
10828no option splice-request
10829 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10831 yes | yes | yes | yes
10832 Arguments : none
10833
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010834 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010835 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010836 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10837 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10838 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10839 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10840
10841 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10842
10843 Example :
10844 option splice-request
10845
10846 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10847 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10848
10849 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10850 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10851
10852
10853option splice-response
10854no option splice-response
10855 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10857 yes | yes | yes | yes
10858 Arguments : none
10859
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010860 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010861 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010862 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10863 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10864 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10865 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10866
10867 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10868
10869 Example :
10870 option splice-response
10871
10872 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10873 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10874
10875 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10876 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10877
10878
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010879option spop-check
10880 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +010010882 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010883 Arguments : none
10884
10885 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10886 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10887 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10888 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10889
10890 Example :
10891 option spop-check
10892
10893 See also : "option httpchk"
10894
10895
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010896option srvtcpka
10897no option srvtcpka
10898 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10900 yes | no | yes | yes
10901 Arguments : none
10902
10903 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10904 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010905 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010906 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10907
10908 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10909 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10910 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10911 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10912
10913 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10914 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10915 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10916 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10917 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10918
10919 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10920
10921 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10922 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10923 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10924
10925 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10926 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10927
10928 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10929
10930
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010931option ssl-hello-chk
10932 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10934 yes | no | yes | yes
10935 Arguments : none
10936
10937 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10938 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10939 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10940 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10941 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10942 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10943 hello message.
10944
10945 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10946 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10947 messages, which is appreciable.
10948
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010949 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010950 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10951 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010952
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010953 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10954
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010955
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010956option tcp-check
10957 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10958 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10959 yes | no | yes | yes
10960
10961 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10962 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10963
10964 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10965 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10966 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10967
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010968 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010969 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10970 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10971 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10972 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10973 only.
10974
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010975 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010976 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010977 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10978 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10979 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10980
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010981 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010982 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10983 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010984 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010985 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10986 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10987 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10988 the respective protocols.
10989 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010990 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010991
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010992 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010993
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010994 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10995 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10996 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10997 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010998
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010999 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
11000 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
11001 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011002
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020011003
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011004 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011005 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011006 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020011007 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011008
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011009 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011010 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020011011 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011012
11013 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
11014 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011015 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011016 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020011017 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011018 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011019 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020011020 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011021 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11022 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020011023 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011024 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11025 tcp-check expect string +OK
11026
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011027 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011028 (send many headers before analyzing)
11029 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020011030 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011031 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
11032 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
11033 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
11034 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020011035 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011036
11037
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011038 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011039
11040
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020011041option tcp-smart-accept
11042no option tcp-smart-accept
11043 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
11044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11045 yes | yes | yes | no
11046 Arguments : none
11047
11048 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
11049 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
11050 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
11051 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
11052 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
11053 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
11054
11055 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
11056 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
11057 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
11058 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
11059
11060 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
11061 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
11062 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011063 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020011064
11065 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
11066 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
11067 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
11068
11069 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
11070 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
11071 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
11072
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020011073 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
11074
11075
11076option tcp-smart-connect
11077no option tcp-smart-connect
11078 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
11079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11080 yes | no | yes | yes
11081 Arguments : none
11082
11083 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
11084 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
11085 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
11086 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
11087 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
11088
11089 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
11090 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
11091 complex.
11092
11093 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
11094 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
11095 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
11096
11097 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
11098 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
11099
11100 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
11101
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020011102
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011103option tcpka
11104 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
11105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11106 yes | yes | yes | yes
11107 Arguments : none
11108
11109 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
11110 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011111 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011112 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
11113
11114 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
11115 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
11116 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
11117 operating system and its tuning parameters.
11118
11119 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
11120 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
11121 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
11122 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
11123 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
11124
11125 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
11126
11127 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
11128 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
11129 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
11130 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
11131 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
11132 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
11133 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
11134 backends.
11135
11136 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
11137
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011138
11139option tcplog
11140 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
11141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010011142 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011143 Arguments : none
11144
11145 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
11146 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
11147 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
11148 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
11149 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
11150 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
11151 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
11152 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
11153
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020011154 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
11155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011156 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011157
11158
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011159option transparent
11160no option transparent
11161 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011163 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011164 Arguments : none
11165
11166 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
11167 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11168 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11169 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11170 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11171 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11172 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11173 appropriate server.
11174
11175 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11176 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11177
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010011178 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011179 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011180
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011181
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011182external-check command <command>
11183 Executable to run when performing an external-check
11184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11185 yes | no | yes | yes
11186
11187 Arguments :
11188 <command> is the external command to run
11189
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011190 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
11191
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011192 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011193
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011194 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
11195 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
11196 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
11197 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
11198 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
11199 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011200
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011201 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
11202
11203 Environment variables :
11204 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
11205 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
11206
11207 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
11208
11209 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
11210
11211 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
11212 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
11213 for a UNIX socket).
11214
11215 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
11216
11217 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
11218
11219 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
11220
11221 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
11222
11223 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
11224
11225 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
11226 socket).
11227
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020011228 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
11229
11230 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
11231 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
11232 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
11233 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
11234 TCP server).
11235
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011236 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
11237 the command may be set using "external-check path".
11238
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020011239 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
11240
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011241 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
11242 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
11243 failed.
11244
11245 Example :
11246 external-check command /bin/true
11247
11248 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
11249
11250
11251external-check path <path>
11252 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
11253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11254 yes | no | yes | yes
11255
11256 Arguments :
11257 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
11258
11259 The default path is "".
11260
11261 Example :
11262 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
11263
11264 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
11265 "external-check command"
11266
11267
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011268persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020011269persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011270 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
11271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11272 yes | no | yes | yes
11273 Arguments :
11274 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011275 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
11276 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011277
11278 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
11279 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011280 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011281 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
11282 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
11283 forwarded to this server.
11284
11285 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
11286 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
11287 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011288 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011289 a single "listen" section.
11290
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011291 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
11292 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
11293 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
11294
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011295 Example :
11296 listen tse-farm
11297 bind :3389
11298 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11299 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11300 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11301 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11302 persist rdp-cookie
11303 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011304 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011305 balance rdp-cookie
11306 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11307 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
11308
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011309 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011310
11311
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011312rate-limit sessions <rate>
11313 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
11314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11315 yes | yes | yes | no
11316 Arguments :
11317 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
11318 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
11319
11320 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
11321 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
11322 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011323 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011324 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
11325 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
11326
11327 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
11328 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
11329 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
11330 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
11331
11332 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
11333 listen smtp
11334 mode tcp
11335 bind :25
11336 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020011337 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011338
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020011339 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
11340 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
11341 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011342
11343 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
11344
11345
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011346redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11347redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11348redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011349 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
11350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11351 no | yes | yes | yes
11352
11353 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010011354 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011355
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011356 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011357 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011358 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
11359 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020011360 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011361
11362 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
11363 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
11364 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
11365 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
11366 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011367 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
11368 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
11369 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020011370 in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011371
11372 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
11373 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
11374 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
11375 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
11376 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
11377 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011378 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011379 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011380 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
11381 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020011382 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011383
11384 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011385 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
11386 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
11387 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020011388 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011389 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
11390 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
11391 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
11392 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011393
11394 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011395 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011396
11397 - "drop-query"
11398 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
11399 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
11400 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
11401 with a location-type redirect.
11402
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011403 - "append-slash"
11404 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
11405 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
11406 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
11407 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
11408
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011409 - "ignore-empty"
11410 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
11411 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
11412 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
11413 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
11414 of known paths using a simple map.
11415
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011416 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
11417 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
11418 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
11419 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
11420 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
11421 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
11422 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
11423
11424 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
11425 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
11426 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
11427 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
11428 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
11429 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
11430 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011431
11432 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
11433 acl clear dst_port 80
11434 acl secure dst_port 8080
11435 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011436 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011437 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011438 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
11439
11440 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011441 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
11442 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
11443 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011444 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011445
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011446 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
11447 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
11448 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
11449
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011450 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010011451 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011452
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011453 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020011454 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11455 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
11456 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011457
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011458 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
11459 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11460 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
11461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011462 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011463
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010011464
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011465retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011466 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011467 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11468 yes | no | yes | yes
11469 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011470 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
11471 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011472
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011473 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
11474 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
11475 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
11476 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
11477 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011478
11479 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070011480 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011481 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011482
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011483 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
11484 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
11485 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011486
11487 See also : "option redispatch"
11488
11489
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011490retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020011491 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
11492 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
11493 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011494 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11495 yes | no | yes | yes
11496 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011497 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
11498 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
11499 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
11500 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
11501 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011502
11503 none never retry
11504
11505 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
11506 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
11507
11508 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
11509 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
11510 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
11511 request timeout on the server side, poor network
11512 condition, or a server crash or restart while
11513 processing the request.
11514
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020011515 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
11516 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
11517 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
11518 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
11519 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
11520 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
11521 overflow attack for example).
11522
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011523 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
11524 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
11525 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
11526 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
11527 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
11528 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
11529 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
11530 amplify denial of service attacks.
11531
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020011532 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
11533 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
11534 considered to be safe to retry.
11535
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010011536 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
11537 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
11538 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
11539 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
11540 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011541
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011542 all-retryable-errors
11543 retry request for any error that are considered
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +010011544 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
11545 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
11546 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011547
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011548 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
11549 not cumulative.
11550
11551 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
11552 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
11553 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
11554 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
11555
11556 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
11557 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
11558 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
11559 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
11560 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
11561 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
11562 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
11563 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
11564 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
11565 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
11566 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
11567 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
11568
11569 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
11570 should not use this directive.
11571
11572 The default is "conn-failure".
11573
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011574 Example:
11575 retry-on 503 504
11576
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011577 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
11578
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011579server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011580 Declare a server in a backend
11581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11582 no | no | yes | yes
11583 Arguments :
11584 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011585 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011586 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011587
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011588 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
11589 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
11590 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
11591 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011592 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
11593 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011594 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011595 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
11596 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011597 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
11598 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
11599 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
11600 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
11601 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11602 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11603 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011604 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020011605 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
11606 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
11607 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
11608 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
11609 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
11610 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011611 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11612 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011613 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
11614 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011615
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011616 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011617 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
11618 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
11619 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
11620 adding this value to the client's port.
11621
11622 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
11623 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011624 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011625
11626 Examples :
11627 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
11628 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011629 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011630 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
11631 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
11632 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011633
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020011634 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
11635 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
11636 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
11637 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
11638 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
11639
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011640 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
11641 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011642
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011643server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011644 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011645 this backend.
11646 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11647 no | no | yes | yes
11648
11649 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
11650 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
11651 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
11652 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
11653 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011654
11655 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
11656 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
11657
11658 global
11659 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
11660
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010011661 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011662 load-server-state-from-file
11663
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011664 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011665 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011666
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020011667server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
11668 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
11669 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
11670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11671 no | no | yes | yes
11672
11673 Arguments:
11674 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
11675
11676 <num | range>
11677 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
11678 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
11679 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
11680 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
11681
11682 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
11683
11684 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
11685
11686 <params*>
11687 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
11688 keyword.
11689
11690 Examples:
11691 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
11692 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
11693 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
11694
11695 # or
11696 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
11697
11698 # would be equivalent to:
11699 server srv1 google.com:80 check
11700 server srv2 google.com:80 check
11701 server srv3 google.com:80 check
11702
11703
11704
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011705source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011706source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011707source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011708 Set the source address for outgoing connections
11709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11710 yes | no | yes | yes
11711 Arguments :
11712 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
11713 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011714
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011715 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011716 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
11717 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
11718 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
11719 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
11720 supported prefixes are :
11721 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11722 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11723 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011724 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011725 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11726 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011727
11728 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
11729 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011730 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
11731 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
11732 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011733
11734 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
11735 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
11736 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
11737 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
11738 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
11739 <addr>.
11740
11741 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11742 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11743 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11744 port.
11745
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011746 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11747 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11748 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11749 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011750 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011751 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11752 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11753 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11754 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11755 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11756 HTTP header.
11757
11758 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11759 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011760 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011761 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11762 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11763 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11764 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11765 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11766 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11767 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11768
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011769 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11770 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11771 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11772 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11773 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11774 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11775
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011776 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11777 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11778 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11779 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11780
11781 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11782 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11783 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11784 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11785 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11786 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11787
11788 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11789 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11790 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11791 there are two methods :
11792
11793 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11794 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11795 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11796 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11797 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11798 of the client ranges may be used.
11799
11800 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11801 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11802 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11803 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11804 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11805 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11806 same session.
11807
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011808 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11809 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11810 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011811 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011812
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +020011813 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges, or on supported systems,
11814 the "cap_net_raw" capability. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011815
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011816 Examples :
11817 backend private
11818 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11819 source 192.168.1.200
11820
11821 backend transparent_ssl1
11822 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11823 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11824
11825 backend transparent_ssl2
11826 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11827 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11828 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11829
11830 backend transparent_ssl3
11831 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11832 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11833 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11834
11835 backend transparent_smtp
11836 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11837 # with Tproxy version 4.
11838 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11839
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011840 backend transparent_http
11841 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11842 # proxy.
11843 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011845 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011846 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11847
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011848
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011849srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11850 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11851 the connection on the server side.
11852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11853 yes | no | yes | yes
11854 Arguments :
11855 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11856
11857 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11858 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011859 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11860 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011861
11862 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11863
11864
11865srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11866 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11867 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11868 server side.
11869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11870 yes | no | yes | yes
11871 Arguments :
11872 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11873 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11874 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11875 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11876
11877 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11878 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011879 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11880 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011881
11882 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11883
11884
11885srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11886 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11888 yes | no | yes | yes
11889 Arguments :
11890 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11891 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11892 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11893 document.
11894
11895 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11896 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011897 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11898 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011899
11900 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11901
11902
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011903stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11904 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011906 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011907
11908 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11909 matched.
11910
11911 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11912 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11913
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011914 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11915 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11916 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11917 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011918
11919 Example :
11920 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11921 backend stats_localhost
11922 stats enable
11923 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11924
11925 Example :
11926 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11927 backend stats_auth
11928 stats enable
11929 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11930 stats admin if TRUE
11931
11932 Example :
11933 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11934 userlist stats-auth
11935 group admin users admin
11936 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11937 group readonly users haproxy
11938 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11939
11940 backend stats_auth
11941 stats enable
11942 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11943 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11944 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11945 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11946
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011947 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11948 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011949
11950
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011951stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11952 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011954 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011955 Arguments :
11956 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11957
11958 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11959
11960 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11961 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11962 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11963 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11964 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11965 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11966
11967 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11968 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11969 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011970 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011971
11972 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11973 report using "stats scope".
11974
11975 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11976 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11977 unobvious parameters.
11978
11979 Example :
11980 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11981 backend public_www
11982 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11983 stats enable
11984 stats hide-version
11985 stats scope .
11986 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011987 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011988 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11989 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11990
11991 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11992 backend private_monitoring
11993 stats enable
11994 stats uri /admin?stats
11995 stats refresh 5s
11996
11997 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11998
11999
12000stats enable
12001 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
12002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012003 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012004 Arguments : none
12005
12006 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
12007 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
12008 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
12009 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
12010 - stats auth : no authentication
12011 - stats scope : no restriction
12012
12013 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12014 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12015 unobvious parameters.
12016
12017 Example :
12018 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12019 backend public_www
12020 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12021 stats enable
12022 stats hide-version
12023 stats scope .
12024 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012025 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012026 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12027 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12028
12029 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12030 backend private_monitoring
12031 stats enable
12032 stats uri /admin?stats
12033 stats refresh 5s
12034
12035 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12036
12037
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012038stats hide-version
12039 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012041 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012042 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012043
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012044 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
12045 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
12046 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
12047 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
12048 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
12049 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020012051 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12052 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12053 unobvious parameters.
12054
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012055 Example :
12056 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12057 backend public_www
12058 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020012059 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012060 stats hide-version
12061 stats scope .
12062 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012063 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012064 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12065 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012066
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012067 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12068 backend private_monitoring
12069 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012070 stats uri /admin?stats
12071 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010012072
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012073 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012074
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012075
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020012076stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
12077 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12078 Access control for statistics
12079
12080 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12081 no | no | yes | yes
12082
12083 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
12084 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
12085 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
12086 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
12087 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
12088 should be asked to enter a username and password.
12089
12090 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
12091 instance.
12092
12093 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
12094 about ACL usage.
12095
12096
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012097stats realm <realm>
12098 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
12099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012100 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012101 Arguments :
12102 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
12103 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
12104 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
12105
12106 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
12107 using a backslash ('\').
12108
12109 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
12110 only related to authentication.
12111
12112 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12113 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12114 unobvious parameters.
12115
12116 Example :
12117 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12118 backend public_www
12119 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12120 stats enable
12121 stats hide-version
12122 stats scope .
12123 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012124 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012125 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12126 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12127
12128 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12129 backend private_monitoring
12130 stats enable
12131 stats uri /admin?stats
12132 stats refresh 5s
12133
12134 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
12135
12136
12137stats refresh <delay>
12138 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
12139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012140 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012141 Arguments :
12142 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
12143 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
12144 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
12145 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
12146 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
12147 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
12148
12149 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
12150 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
12151 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050012152 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012153
12154 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12155 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12156 unobvious parameters.
12157
12158 Example :
12159 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12160 backend public_www
12161 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12162 stats enable
12163 stats hide-version
12164 stats scope .
12165 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012166 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012167 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12168 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12169
12170 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12171 backend private_monitoring
12172 stats enable
12173 stats uri /admin?stats
12174 stats refresh 5s
12175
12176 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12177
12178
12179stats scope { <name> | "." }
12180 Enable statistics and limit access scope
12181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012182 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012183 Arguments :
12184 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
12185 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
12186 section in which the statement appears.
12187
12188 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
12189 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
12190 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
12191 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
12192 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
12193 exists.
12194
12195 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12196 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12197 unobvious parameters.
12198
12199 Example :
12200 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12201 backend public_www
12202 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12203 stats enable
12204 stats hide-version
12205 stats scope .
12206 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012207 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012208 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12209 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12210
12211 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12212 backend private_monitoring
12213 stats enable
12214 stats uri /admin?stats
12215 stats refresh 5s
12216
12217 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12218
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012219
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012220stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012221 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
12222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012223 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012224
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012225 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012226 description from global section is automatically used instead.
12227
12228 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12229 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
12230
12231 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12232 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012233 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012234
12235 Example :
12236 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12237 backend private_monitoring
12238 stats enable
12239 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
12240 stats uri /admin?stats
12241 stats refresh 5s
12242
12243 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
12244 global section.
12245
12246
12247stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012248 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
12249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12250 yes | yes | yes | yes
12251 Arguments : none
12252
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012253 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012254 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
12255 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
12256 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
12257 - IP (socket, server)
12258 - cookie (backend, server)
12259
12260 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12261 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012262 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012263
12264 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12265
12266
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020012267stats show-modules
12268 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
12269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12270 yes | yes | yes | yes
12271 Arguments : none
12272
12273 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
12274 values as a tooltip.
12275
12276 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12277 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12278 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
12279
12280 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12281
12282
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012283stats show-node [ <name> ]
12284 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
12285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012286 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012287 Arguments:
12288 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
12289 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
12290
12291 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12292 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012293 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012294
12295 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12296 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12297 unobvious parameters.
12298
12299 Example:
12300 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12301 backend private_monitoring
12302 stats enable
12303 stats show-node Europe-1
12304 stats uri /admin?stats
12305 stats refresh 5s
12306
12307 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
12308 section.
12309
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012310
12311stats uri <prefix>
12312 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
12313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012314 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012315 Arguments :
12316 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
12317 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
12318 query string.
12319
12320 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
12321 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
12322 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
12323 possible to reach it in the application.
12324
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012325 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012326 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012327 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
12328 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
12329 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
12330 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
12331
12332 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
12333 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
12334 an address or a port to statistics only.
12335
12336 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12337 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12338 unobvious parameters.
12339
12340 Example :
12341 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12342 backend public_www
12343 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12344 stats enable
12345 stats hide-version
12346 stats scope .
12347 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012348 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012349 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12350 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12351
12352 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12353 backend private_monitoring
12354 stats enable
12355 stats uri /admin?stats
12356 stats refresh 5s
12357
12358 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
12359
12360
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012361stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
12362 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012364 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012365
12366 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012367 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012368 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012369 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012370 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
12371
12372 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12373 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12374 the "stick-table" statement.
12375
12376 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
12377 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
12378 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
12379 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
12380 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
12381
12382 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12383 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
12384 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
12385 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
12386 transformation rules.
12387
12388 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12389 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12390 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12391 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12392 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12393 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12394 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12395
12396 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
12397 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
12398 ACL based conditions.
12399
12400 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
12401 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
12402 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
12403 matches can be used as fallbacks.
12404
12405 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
12406 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
12407 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
12408 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
12409
12410 Example :
12411 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12412 # last 30 minutes
12413 backend pop
12414 mode tcp
12415 balance roundrobin
12416 stick store-request src
12417 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12418 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12419 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12420
12421 backend smtp
12422 mode tcp
12423 balance roundrobin
12424 stick match src table pop
12425 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12426 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12427
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012428 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
12429 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012430
12431
12432stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12433 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
12434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12435 no | no | yes | yes
12436
12437 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
12438 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
12439 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
12440 for writing more maintainable configurations.
12441
12442 Examples :
12443 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010012444 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012445
12446 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
12447 stick match src table pop if !localhost
12448 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
12449
12450
12451 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
12452 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
12453 backend http
12454 mode http
12455 balance roundrobin
12456 stick on src table https
12457 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
12458 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
12459 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
12460
12461 backend https
12462 mode tcp
12463 balance roundrobin
12464 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12465 stick on src
12466 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12467 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12468
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012469 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012470
12471
12472stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12473 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
12474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12475 no | no | yes | yes
12476
12477 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012478 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012479 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012480 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012481 server is selected.
12482
12483 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12484 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12485 the "stick-table" statement.
12486
12487 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12488 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12489 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
12490 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
12491 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
12492 address.
12493
12494 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12495 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
12496 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
12497 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
12498 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
12499 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
12500 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
12501 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
12502 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
12503 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
12504
12505 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12506 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12507 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12508 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12509 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12510 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12511 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12512
12513 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
12514 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12515 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
12516 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12517
12518 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
12519 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12520 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12521 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12522 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12523 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012524 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
12525 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12526 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12527 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12528 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12529 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012530
12531 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
12532 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
12533 the request.
12534
12535 Example :
12536 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12537 # last 30 minutes
12538 backend pop
12539 mode tcp
12540 balance roundrobin
12541 stick store-request src
12542 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12543 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12544 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12545
12546 backend smtp
12547 mode tcp
12548 balance roundrobin
12549 stick match src table pop
12550 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12551 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12552
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012553 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012554
12555
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012556stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012557 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012558 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080012559 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012561 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012562
12563 Arguments :
12564 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
12565 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
12566 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12567 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12568
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010012569 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
12570 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
12571 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12572 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12573
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012574 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
12575 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
12576 instance.
12577
12578 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
12579 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
12580 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
12581 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
12582 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
12583 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012584 to 32 characters.
12585
12586 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
12587 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
12588 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012589 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012590 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
12591 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012592
12593 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012594 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
12595 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012596 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
12597 increase.
12598
12599 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012600 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
12601 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
12602 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012603
12604 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012605 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012606 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
12607 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012608 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012609 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
12610 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
12611 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
12612 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
12613 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
12614 parameter (see below).
12615
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012616 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
12617 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
12618 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
12619 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
12620 soft restart.
12621
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012622 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012623 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
12624 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012625 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
12626 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012627 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012628 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012629 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
12630 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012631 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
12632 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012633
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012634 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
12635 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
12636 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
12637 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
12638 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
12639 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
12640 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
12641 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
12642 token.
12643
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012644 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
12645 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
12646 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
12647 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012648 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
12649 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
12650 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
12651 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
12652 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
12653 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
12654 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
12655 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
12656 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
12657 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
12658 types and their arguments.
12659
12660 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
12661 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
12662 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
12663 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
12664
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012665 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
12666 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
12667 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
12668 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
12669 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
12670 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
12671 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
12672 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
12673 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
12674 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012675 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
12676 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
12677 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
12678 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012679
12680 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
12681 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
12682 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
12683 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
12684 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
12685 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012686 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
12687 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
12688 update message can fit into the buffer.
12689 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
12690 store only the counter gpc0.
12691 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012692 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
12693 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
12694 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012695 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
12696 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
12697 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
12698 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012699
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012700 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12701 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12702 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012703 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012704
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012705 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12706 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12707 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012708 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012709 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012710 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012711
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012712 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12713 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12714 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12715 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
12716
12717 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
12718 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12719 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
12720 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
12721 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
12722 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
12723
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012724 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
12725 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
12726 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
12727 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
12728 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012729 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
12730 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
12731 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
12732 to store only the tag gpt0.
12733 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
12734 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
12735 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020012736 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
12737 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
12738 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012739
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020012740 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12741 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12742 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12743 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12744
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012745 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12746 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12747 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12748 they were received.
12749
12750 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12751 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12752 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12753 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12754 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12755
12756 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12757 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12758 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12759 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12760 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12761
12762 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12763 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12764 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12765
12766 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12767 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12768 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12769 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12770 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12771
12772 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12773 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12774 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12775 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12776 the client side.
12777
12778 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12779 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12780 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12781 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12782 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12783 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12784 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12785
12786 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12787 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12788 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12789 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12790 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12791 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012792 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012793
12794 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12795 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12796 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12797 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12798 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12799 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12800
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012801 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12802 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12803 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12804 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12805 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12806
12807 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12808 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12809 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12810 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12811 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12812 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12813
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012814 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012815 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012816 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12817 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12818
12819 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12820 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12821 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12822 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12823 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12824 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12825 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12826 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12827 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12828 recommended for better fairness.
12829
12830 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012831 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012832 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12833 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12834
12835 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12836 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12837 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12838 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12839 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12840 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12841 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12842 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12843 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12844 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012845
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012846 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12847 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012848 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12849 reference it.
12850
12851 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12852 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012853 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12854 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12855 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012856
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012857 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12858 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12859 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12860 something that can be ignored.
12861
12862 Example:
12863 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12864 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12865 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12866 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12867
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012868 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012869 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012870
12871
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012872stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012873 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12875 no | no | yes | yes
12876
12877 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012878 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012879 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012880 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012881 server is selected.
12882
12883 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12884 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12885 the "stick-table" statement.
12886
12887 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12888 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12889 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12890 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12891
12892 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12893 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12894 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12895 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12896 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12897 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012898 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012899 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12900 rules.
12901
12902 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12903 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12904 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12905 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12906 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12907 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12908 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12909
12910 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12911 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12912 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12913 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12914
12915 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12916 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12917 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12918 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12919 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12920 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012921 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12922 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12923 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12924 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12925 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12926 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12927 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12928 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12929 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012930
12931 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12932
12933 Example :
12934 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12935 backend https
12936 mode tcp
12937 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012938 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012939 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012940
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012941 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
William Lallemand8244cb72023-12-07 15:00:58 +010012942 acl serverhello res.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012943
12944 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12945 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12946 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12947
12948 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12949 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012950
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012951 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12952 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12953 # at offset 44.
12954
12955 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012956 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012957
12958 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012959 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012960
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012961 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12962 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12963
12964 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12965 extraction.
12966
12967
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012968tcp-check comment <string>
12969 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12970 it fails.
12971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12972 yes | no | yes | yes
12973
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012974 Arguments :
12975 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12976 rule fails.
12977
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012978 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12979 user-friendly error reporting.
12980
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012981 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12982 "tcp-check expect".
12983
12984
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012985tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12986 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012987 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012988 Opens a new connection
12989 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012990 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012991
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012992 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012993 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12994
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012995 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012996 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012997
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012998 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012999 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
13000 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020013001 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020013002
13003 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013004
13005 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
13006
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020013007 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
13008
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013009 ssl opens a ciphered connection
13010
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020013011 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
13012
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020013013 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
13014 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
13015 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
13016 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13017
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013018 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
13019 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
13020 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
13021 haproxy -vv.
13022
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020013023 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013024
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013025 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
13026 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
13027 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
13028
13029 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
13030 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
13031 of the sequence.
13032
13033 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
13034 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
13035 do.
13036
13037 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
13038 unset-var or comment rules.
13039
13040 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013041 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
13042 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
13043 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
13044 option tcp-check
13045 tcp-check connect
13046 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
13047 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
13048 tcp-check send \r\n
13049 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
13050 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
13051 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
13052 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
13053 tcp-check send \r\n
13054 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
13055 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
13056
13057 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
13058 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013059 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013060 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
13061 tcp-check connect port 143
13062 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
13063 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
13064
13065 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
13066
13067
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013068tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013069 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020013070 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013071 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013072 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013073 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013074 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013075
13076 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013077 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
13078
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013079 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
13080 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
13081 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
13082 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
13083 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
13084 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
13085 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
13086 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
13087 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
13088 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
13089
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013090 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013091 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
13092 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013093 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
13094 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
13095 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
13096
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013097 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
13098 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
13099 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013100 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
13101 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010013102 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
13103 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013104 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
13105 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013106 By default "L7OK" is used.
13107
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013108 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
13109 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010013110 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
13111 supported :
13112 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
13113 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013114 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13115 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
13116 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13117 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
13118 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013119
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013120 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013121 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013122 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
13123 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13124 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13125 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013126 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
13127
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020013128 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
13129 informational message reported in logs if the expect
13130 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
13131 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
13132
13133 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
13134 informational message reported in logs if an error
13135 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
13136 log-format string.
13137
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020013138 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
13139 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
13140 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
13141 followed by some converters.
13142
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013143 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
13144 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
13145 with the usual backslash ('\').
13146 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013147 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013148 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
13149 used upper or lower case.
13150
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013151 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
13152
13153 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
13154 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13155 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
13156 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13157 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
13158 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
13159 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
13160 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
13161
13162 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
13163 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13164 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
13165 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13166 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
13167 expression.
13168
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013169 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
13170 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13171 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
13172 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
13173 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13174 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
13175
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013176 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
13177 in the response buffer. A health check response will
13178 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
13179 this exact hexadecimal string.
13180 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
13181
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013182 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
13183 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
13184 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
13185 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
13186 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
13187 size of the original response. As such, the expected
13188 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
13189 size.
13190
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013191 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
13192 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
13193 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
13194 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
13195 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
13196 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13197 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
13198 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
13199 in a binary string before matching the response's
13200 buffer.
13201
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013202 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013203 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013204 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
13205 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
13206 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
13207 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
13208 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
13209 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
13210 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
13211 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
13212 the null character.
13213
13214 Examples :
13215 # perform a POP check
13216 option tcp-check
13217 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
13218
13219 # perform an IMAP check
13220 option tcp-check
13221 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
13222
13223 # look for the redis master server
13224 option tcp-check
13225 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020013226 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013227 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13228 tcp-check expect string role:master
13229 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
13230 tcp-check expect string +OK
13231
13232
13233 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013234 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013235
13236
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013237tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
13238tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
13239 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
13240 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013241 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013242 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013243
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013244 Arguments :
13245 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
13246
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013247 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
13248 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013249
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013250 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
13251 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013252
13253 Examples :
13254 # look for the redis master server
13255 option tcp-check
13256 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13257 tcp-check expect string role:master
13258
13259 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013260 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013261
13262
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013263tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
13264tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
13265 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
13266 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013267 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013268 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013269
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013270 Arguments :
13271 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013272
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013273 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
13274 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013275
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013276 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
13277 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
13278 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013279
13280 Examples :
13281 # redis check in binary
13282 option tcp-check
13283 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
13284 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
13285
13286
13287 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013288 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013289
13290
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013291tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13292tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013293 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013294 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013295 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013296
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013297 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013298 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13299 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13300 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13301 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13302 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13303 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13304 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13305 and '-'.
13306
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013307 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
13308 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050013309 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013310 conditions.
13311
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013312 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
13313
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013314 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020013315 Log Format in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013316
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013317 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013318 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013319 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013320
13321
13322tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013323 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013324 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013325 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013326
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013327 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013328 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13329 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13330 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13331 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13332 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13333 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13334 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13335 and '-'.
13336
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013337 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013338 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
13339
13340
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013341tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013342 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013344 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013345 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013346 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13347 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013348
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013349 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013350
13351 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
13352 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013353 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
13354 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
13355 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
13356 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
13357 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
13358 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013359
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013360 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13361 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13362 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013363 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
13364 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
13365 is true.
13366
13367 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13368 supported:
13369 - accept
13370 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13371 - expect-proxy layer4
13372 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013373 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013374 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13375 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13376 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13377 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13378 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13379 - set-dst <expr>
13380 - set-dst-port <expr>
13381 - set-mark <mark>
13382 - set-src <expr>
13383 - set-src-port <expr>
13384 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013385 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13386 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013387 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013388 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13389 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13390 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013391 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013392
13393 The supported actions are described below.
13394
13395 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
13396 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013397
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013398 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13399 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13400 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13401 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13402 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13403 a defaults section defining such rules.
13404
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013405 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13406 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13407 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013408
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013409 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13410 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
13411 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013412
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013413 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13414 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
13415 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013416
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013417 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
13418 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13419 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013420
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013421 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13422 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13423 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013424
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013425 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013426
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013427 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013428
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013429 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013430
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013431 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013432
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013433tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013434
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013435 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13436 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013437
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013438tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13439 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013440
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013441 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
13442 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
13443 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
13444 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
13445 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
13446 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
13447 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013448
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013449tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013450
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013451 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
13452 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
13453 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
13454 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
13455 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
13456 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013457
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013458tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013459
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013460 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13461 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
13462 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
13463 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
13464 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
13465 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
13466 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
13467 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
13468 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
13469 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
13470 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013471
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013472tcp-request connection sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13473 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13474
13475 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13476 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13477 a complete description.
13478
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013479tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13480tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13481tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013482
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013483 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13484 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13485 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13486 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013487
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013488tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13489 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13490tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13491 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013492
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013493 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13494 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013495 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013496
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013497tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13498tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013499
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013500 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13501 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13502 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013503
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013504tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013505
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013506 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13507 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13508 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013509
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013510tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13511tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013512
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013513 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13514 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13515 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013516
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013517tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013518
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013519 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13520 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13521 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013522
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013523tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13524tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013525
13526 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13527 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
13528 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13529 for a complete description.
13530
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013531tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013532
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013533 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13534 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13535 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13536 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013537
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013538tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13539tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13540tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013541
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013542 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13543 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13544 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013545
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013546tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13547
13548 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13549 details about variables.
13550
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013551
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013552tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13553 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013555 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013556 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013557 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13558 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013559
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013560 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013561
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013562 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013563 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13564 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013565 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
13566 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013567
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013568 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
13569 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
13570 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
13571 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013572 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013573 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013574 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
13575 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
13576 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
13577 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013578 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013579 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013580
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013581 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13582 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13583 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13584 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013585
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013586 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13587 supported:
13588 - accept
13589 - capture <sample> len <length>
13590 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13591 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013592 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013593 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013594 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013595 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013596 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010013597 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013598 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013599 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020013600 - set-dst <expr>
13601 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013602 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013603 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013604 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013605 - set-priority-class <expr>
13606 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013607 - set-src <expr>
13608 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013609 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013610 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13611 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013612 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013613 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013614 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13615 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13616 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013617 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013618 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013619
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013620 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013621
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013622 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
13623 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
13624 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
13625 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
13626 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
13627 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013628
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013629 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13630 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13631 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13632 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13633 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13634 a defaults section defining such rules.
13635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013636 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013637 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13638 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013639
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020013640 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
13641 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
13642 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
13643 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
13644 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
13645 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
13646
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013647 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020013648 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
13649 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
13650 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
13651 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
13652 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
13653 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
13654 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
13655 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
13656 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
13657 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013658
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013659 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013660 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
13661 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
13662 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013663
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013664 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020013665 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013666
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013667 Example:
13668
13669 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013670 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013671 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013672
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013673 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013674 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013675 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013676 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13677 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020013678 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013679 tcp-request content reject
13680
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013681 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
13682 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
13683 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13684 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13685 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
13686 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
13687 ...
13688 http-request reject unless is_host_com
13689
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013690 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013691 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
13692 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013693 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013694 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013695
13696 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
13697 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013698 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013699 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013700 tcp-request content reject
13701
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013702 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013703 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013704 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013705 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013706 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
13707 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013708
13709 Example:
13710 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13711 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013712 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013713
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013714 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013715 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013716
13717 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013718 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013719 # protecting all our sites
13720 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013721 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13722 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013723 ...
13724 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
13725
13726 backend http_dynamic
13727 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013728 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013729 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013730 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013731 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013732 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013733 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013735 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013736
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030013737 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
13738 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013739
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013740tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13741
13742 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010013743 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013744
13745tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
13746 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13747
13748 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
13749 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
13750 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13751 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13752 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13753 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13754 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13755 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13756 information.
13757
13758tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13759
13760 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13761 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13762 complete description.
13763
13764tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13765
13766 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13767 are evaluated.
13768
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013769tcp-request content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13770 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13771
13772 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13773 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13774 a complete description.
13775
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013776tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13777tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13778tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13779
13780 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13781 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13782 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13783 description.
13784
13785tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13786 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13787tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13788 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13789
13790 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13791 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013792 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013793
13794tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13795 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13796
Willy Tarreau707742f2023-11-30 09:27:51 +010013797 This action is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013798 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13799
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013800tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13801 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013802
13803 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13804 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13805 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13806
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013807tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13808tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13809
13810 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13811 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13812 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13813
13814tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13815
13816 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13817 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13818
13819tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13820
13821 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13822 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13823 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13824
13825tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13826
13827 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13828 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13829
13830tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13831
13832 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13833 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13834
13835tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13836
13837 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13838 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13839 description.
13840
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013841tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13842tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13843
13844 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13845 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13846 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13847
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013848tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13849
13850 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13851 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13852 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13853
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013854tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13855tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013856
13857 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13858 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13859 for a complete description.
13860
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013861tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013862
13863 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13864 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13865 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13866 complete description.
13867
13868tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13869 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13870
13871 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13872 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13873 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13874 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13875 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13876 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13877 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13878 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13879 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13880 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13881
13882 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13883
13884tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13885tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13886tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13887
13888 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13889 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13890 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13891
13892tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13893
13894 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13895 details about variables.
13896
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013897tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013898
13899 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13900 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13901 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13902 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13903 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13904
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013905
13906tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13907 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013909 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013910 Arguments :
13911 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13912 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13913 as explained at the top of this document.
13914
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013915 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013916 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13917 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13918 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13919 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13920
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013921 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13922 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13923 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13924 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13925
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013926 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013927 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013928 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013929 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013930 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013931 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13932 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13933 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013934
Christopher Faulet43525ab2023-05-16 08:15:12 +020013935 Note the inspection delay is shortened if an connection error or shutdown is
13936 experienced or if the request buffer appears as full.
13937
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013938 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13939 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13940 it pass through unaffected.
13941
13942 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13943 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13944 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013945 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013946 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13947 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013948 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13949 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13950 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013951
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013952 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13953 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13954
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013955 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013956 "timeout client".
13957
13958
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013959tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13960 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013962 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013963 Arguments :
13964 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13965 below.
13966
13967 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13968
13969 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13970 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13971 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13972 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013973 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013974 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13975 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13976 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13977 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13978 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13979 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13980 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13981 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13982 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13983 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13984 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13985 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13986 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13987 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13988 instead.
13989
13990 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13991 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13992 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13993 rules which may be inserted.
13994
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013995 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13996 supported:
13997 - accept
13998 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013999 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020014000 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
14001 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
14002 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
14003 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14004 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020014005 - set-dst <expr>
14006 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014007 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020014008 - set-src <expr>
14009 - set-src-port <expr>
14010 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014011 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
14012 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010014013 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014014 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
14015 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
14016 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
14017 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020014018
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014019 The supported actions are described below.
14020
14021 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14022 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
14023 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
14024 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
14025 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
14026 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020014027
14028 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
14029 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
14030 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
14031
14032 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
14033 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
14034 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
14035 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
14036 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
14037
14038 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
14039 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
14040
14041 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
14042 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
14043 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
14044
14045 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
14046 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
14047 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
14048
14049 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
14050 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
14051 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
14052
14053 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
14054 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
14055 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
14056
14057 See section 7 about ACL usage.
14058
14059 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
14060
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014061tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14062
14063 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
14064 rules are evaluated.
14065
14066tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14067
14068 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
14069 are evaluated.
14070
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014071tcp-request session sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14072 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14073
14074 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
14075 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
14076 a complete description.
14077
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014078tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14079tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14080tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14081
14082 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
14083 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
14084 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
14085 description.
14086
14087tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14088 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14089tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14090 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14091
14092 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
14093 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020014094 sc-set-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014095 description.
14096
14097tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14098tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14099
14100 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
14101 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
14102 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
14103
14104tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14105
14106 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
14107 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
14108 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
14109
14110tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14111tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14112
14113 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
14114 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
14115 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
14116
14117tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14118
14119 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
14120 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
14121 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
14122
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014123tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14124tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014125
14126 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
14127 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
14128 for a complete description.
14129
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010014130tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014131
14132 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
14133 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
14134 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
14135 complete description.
14136
14137tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14138tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14139tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14140
14141 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
14142 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
14143 track-sc2" for a complete description.
14144
14145tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14146
14147 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14148 details about variables.
14149
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020014150
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014151tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
14152 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
14153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014154 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014155 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020014156 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
14157 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014158
14159 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
14160
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014161 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014162 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
14163 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014164 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
14165 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014166
14167 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
14168
14169 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
14170 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
14171 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
14172 inserted.
14173
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014174 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
14175 supported:
14176 - accept
14177 - close
14178 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014179 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014180 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
14181 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
14182 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
14183 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14184 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14185 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014186 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014187 - set-log-level <level>
14188 - set-mark <mark>
14189 - set-nice <nice>
14190 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014191 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
14192 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010014193 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014194 - unset-var(<var-name>)
14195
14196 The supported actions are described below.
14197
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014198 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14199 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
14200 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
14201 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
14202 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
14203 a defaults section defining such rules.
14204
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014205 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
14206 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
14207 for changing the default action to a reject.
14208
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014209 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014210
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014211 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
14212 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
14213 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
14214 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
14215 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014216
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014217 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014218
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014219 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020014220
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014221tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014222
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014223 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14224 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020014225
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014226tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014227
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014228 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
14229 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
14230 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
14231 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
14232 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
14233 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014234
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014235tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014236
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014237 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14238 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014239
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014240tcp-response content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14241 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14242
14243 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
14244 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
14245 a complete description.
14246
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014247tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14248tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14249tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020014250
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014251 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
14252 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
14253 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
14254 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020014255
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014256tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14257 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14258tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14259 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014260
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014261 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
14262 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020014263 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020014264
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014265tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
14266 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014267
Willy Tarreau707742f2023-11-30 09:27:51 +010014268 This action is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014269 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020014270
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014271
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014272tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
14273 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014274
14275 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
14276 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
14277 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
14278
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014279tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014280
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014281 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
14282 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014283
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014284tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014285
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014286 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
14287 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
14288 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014289
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014290tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014291
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014292 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
14293 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014294
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014295tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014296
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014297 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
14298 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
14299 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014300
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014301tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14302tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014303
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014304 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
14305 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
14306 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014307
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010014308tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014309
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014310 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
14311 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
14312 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
14313 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014314
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014315tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014316
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014317 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14318 details about variables.
14319
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014320
14321tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
14322 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
14323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014324 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014325 Arguments :
14326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14328 as explained at the top of this document.
14329
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014330 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14331 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014332
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014333 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
14334
14335
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014336timeout check <timeout>
14337 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
14338 established.
14339
14340 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14341 yes | no | yes | yes
14342 Arguments:
14343 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14344 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14345 as explained at the top of this document.
14346
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014347 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014348 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014349 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014350 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010014351 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
14352 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
14353 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014354
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014355 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014356 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
14357
14358 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
14359 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014360 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014361
14362 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14363 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14364 forget about it.
14365
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014366 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
14367 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014368
14369
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014370timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014371 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
14372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14373 yes | yes | yes | no
14374 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014375 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014376 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14377 as explained at the top of this document.
14378
14379 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14380 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14381 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010014382 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
14383 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
14384 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
14385 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014386 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
14387 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
14388 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014389 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014390 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014391 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
14392 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014393 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
14394 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014395
14396 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14397 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14398 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14399 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014400 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014401 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14402
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014403 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014404
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014405
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014406timeout client-fin <timeout>
14407 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
14408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14409 yes | yes | yes | no
14410 Arguments :
14411 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14412 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14413 as explained at the top of this document.
14414
14415 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14416 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14417 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14418 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14419 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
14420 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14421 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010014422 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
14423 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
14424 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014425
14426 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14427 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14428 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
14429
14430 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
14431
14432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014433timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014434 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
14435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14436 yes | no | yes | yes
14437 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014438 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014439 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14440 as explained at the top of this document.
14441
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014442 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014443 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014444 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014445 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014446 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
14447 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014448
14449 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14450 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14451 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14452 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014453 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014454 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14455
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014456 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014457
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014458
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014459timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
14460 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
14461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14462 yes | yes | yes | yes
14463 Arguments :
14464 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14465 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14466 as explained at the top of this document.
14467
14468 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
14469 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
14470 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
14471 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
14472 once the request has started to present itself.
14473
14474 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
14475 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
14476 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
14477 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
14478 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
14479
14480 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
14481 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
14482 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
Willy Tarreau5d43e0f2024-07-17 17:25:40 +020014483 request to complete, an HTTP 408 error is returned to the client before
14484 closing the connection, unless "option http-ignore-probes" is set in the
14485 frontend.
14486
14487 In general "timeout http-keep-alive" is best used to prevent clients from
14488 holding open an otherwise idle connection too long on sites seeing large
14489 amounts of short connections. This can be accomplished by setting the value
14490 to a few tens to hundreds of milliseconds in HTTP/1.1. This will close the
14491 connection after the client requests a page without having to hold that
14492 connection open to wait for more activity from the client. In that scenario,
14493 a new activity from the browser would result in a new handshake at the TCP
14494 and/or SSL layer. A common use case for this is HTTP sites serving only a
14495 redirect to the HTTPS page. Such connections are better not kept idle too
14496 long because they won't be reused, unless maybe to fetch a favicon.
14497
14498 Another use case is the exact opposite: some sites want to permit clients
14499 to reuse idle connections for a long time (e.g. 30 seconds to one minute) but
14500 do not want to wait that long for the first request, in order to avoid a very
14501 inexpensive attack vector. In this case, the http-keep-alive timeout would be
14502 set to a large value, but http-request would remain low (a few seconds).
14503
14504 When set to a very small value additional requests that are not pipelined
14505 are likely going to be handled over another connection unless the requests
14506 are truly pipelined, which is very rare with HTTP/1.1 (requests being sent
14507 back-to-back without waiting for a response). Most HTTP/1.1 implementations
14508 send a request, wait for a response and then send another request. A small
14509 value here for HTTP/1.1 may be advantageous to use less memory and sockets
14510 for sites with hundreds of thousands of clients, at the expense of an
14511 increase in handshake computation costs.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014512
Willy Tarreau5d43e0f2024-07-17 17:25:40 +020014513 Special care should be taken with small values when dealing with HTTP/2. The
14514 nature of HTTP/2 is to multiplex requests over a connection in order to save
14515 on the overhead of reconnecting the TCP and/or SSL layers. The protocol also
14516 uses control frames which cope poorly with early TCP connection closures, on
14517 very rare occasions this may result in truncated responses when data are
14518 destroyed in flight after leaving HAProxy (which then cannot even log an
14519 error). A suggested low starting value for HTTP/2 connections would be around
14520 4 seconds. This would prevent most modern keep-alive implementations from
14521 needlessly holding open stale connections, and at the same time would allow
14522 subsequent requests to reuse the connection. However, this should be adjusted
14523 as needed and is simply a starting point.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014524
14525 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
14526 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
14527 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
14528 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
14529
14530 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
14531
14532
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014533timeout http-request <timeout>
14534 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
14535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014536 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014537 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014538 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014539 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14540 as explained at the top of this document.
14541
14542 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
14543 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
14544 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
14545 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
14546 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
14547 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
14548 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014549 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
14550 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
14551 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
14552 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014553 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014554 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
14555 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014556
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014557 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
14558 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
14559 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
14560 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
14561 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014562 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014563
14564 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
14565 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014566 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014567 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
14568 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
14569
14570 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014571 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
14572 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
14573 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014574
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014575 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014576 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014577
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014578
14579timeout queue <timeout>
14580 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
14581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14582 yes | no | yes | yes
14583 Arguments :
14584 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14585 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14586 as explained at the top of this document.
14587
14588 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
14589 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
14590 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
14591 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
14592 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
14593
14594 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
14595 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
14596 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
14597 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
14598
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014599 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014600
14601
14602timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014603 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
14604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14605 yes | no | yes | yes
14606 Arguments :
14607 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14608 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14609 as explained at the top of this document.
14610
14611 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14612 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14613 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
14614 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
14615 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
14616 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
14617 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
14618
14619 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14620 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14621 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
14622 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
14623 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014624 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014625 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014626 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
14627 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014628 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
14629 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014630
14631 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14632 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14633 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14634 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014635 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014636 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14637
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014638 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014639
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014640
14641timeout server-fin <timeout>
14642 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
14643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14644 yes | no | yes | yes
14645 Arguments :
14646 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14647 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14648 as explained at the top of this document.
14649
14650 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14651 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14652 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14653 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14654 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
14655 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14656 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
14657 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
14658 situations, it should not be needed.
14659
14660 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14661 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14662 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
14663
14664 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
14665
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014666
14667timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014668 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14670 yes | yes | yes | yes
14671 Arguments :
14672 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
14673 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14674 as explained at the top of this document.
14675
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014676 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
14677 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
14678 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014679
14680 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14681 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14682 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
14683 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014684 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014685
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014686 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014687
14688
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014689timeout tunnel <timeout>
14690 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
14691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14692 yes | no | yes | yes
14693 Arguments :
14694 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14695 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14696 as explained at the top of this document.
14697
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014698 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014699 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
14700 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
14701 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014702 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
14703 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014704 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
14705 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
14706 specified.
14707
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014708 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
14709 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
14710 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
14711 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
14712 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
14713 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
14714 state.
14715
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014716 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14717 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14718 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
14719 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014720 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014721
14722 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14723 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14724 forget about it.
14725
14726 Example :
14727 defaults http
14728 option http-server-close
14729 timeout connect 5s
14730 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014731 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014732 timeout server 30s
14733 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
14734
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014735 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014736
14737
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014738transparent (deprecated)
14739 Enable client-side transparent proxying
14740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010014741 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014742 Arguments : none
14743
14744 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
14745 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
14746 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
14747 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
14748 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
14749 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
14750 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
14751 appropriate server.
14752
14753 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
14754
14755 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
14756 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
14757
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014758 See also: "option transparent"
14759
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014760unique-id-format <string>
14761 Generate a unique ID for each request.
14762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14763 yes | yes | yes | no
14764 Arguments :
14765 <string> is a log-format string.
14766
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014767 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
14768 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
14769 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
14770 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014771
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014772 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014773 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014774 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
14775 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
14776 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
14777 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
14778 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
14779 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014780
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014781 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
14782 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014783
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014784 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014785
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014786 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014787
14788 will generate:
14789
14790 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14791
14792 See also: "unique-id-header"
14793
14794unique-id-header <name>
14795 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
14796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14797 yes | yes | yes | no
14798 Arguments :
14799 <name> is the name of the header.
14800
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014801 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
14802 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014803
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014804 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014805
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014806 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014807 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14808
14809 will generate:
14810
14811 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14812
14813 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014814
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014815use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014816 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14818 no | yes | yes | no
14819 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014820 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14821 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014822
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014823 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14824 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014825
14826 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14827 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14828 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014829 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014830 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014831 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14832 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014833
14834 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14835 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14836 assign the backend.
14837
14838 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14839 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14840 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14841 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14842 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14843 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14844
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014845 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014846 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014847 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14848 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14849 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14850
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014851 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14852 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14853 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14854 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14855 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14856 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14857 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14858 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14859 cannot be forced from the request.
14860
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014861 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014862 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14863 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14864
14865 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14866 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014867
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014868use-fcgi-app <name>
14869 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14871 no | no | yes | yes
14872 Arguments :
14873 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14874
14875 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014876
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014877use-server <server> if <condition>
14878use-server <server> unless <condition>
14879 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14881 no | no | yes | yes
14882 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014883 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14884 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014885
14886 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14887
14888 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14889 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14890 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14891
14892 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14893 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14894 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14895 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14896 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14897 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14898 matches will assign the server.
14899
14900 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14901 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14902 with the next rules until one matches.
14903
14904 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14905 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14906 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14907 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14908
14909 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14910 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14911 stripped.
14912
14913 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14914 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014915 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014916 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014917 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014918
14919 Example :
14920 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014921 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014922 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014923 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014924 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014925 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014926 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014927 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14928 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14929
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014930 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14931 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14932 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14933 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014934 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014935 and we fall back to load balancing.
14936
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014937 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014938
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014939
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100149405. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014941--------------------------
14942
14943The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14944depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14945settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14946written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14947described in this section.
14948
14949
149505.1. Bind options
14951-----------------
14952
14953The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14954as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14955no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14956parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14957while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14958provided immediately after the setting name.
14959
14960The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14961
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014962accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14963 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14964 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14965 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14966 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14967 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14968 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14969 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14970 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14971 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014972 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14973 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14974 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014975
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014976accept-proxy
14977 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014978 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14979 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014980 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14981 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14982 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14983 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014984 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014985 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14986 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014987 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14988 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014989
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014990allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014991 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014992 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014993 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014994 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14995 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014996
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014997alpn <protocols>
14998 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14999 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15000 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015001 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015002 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015003 initial NPN extension. At the protocol layer, ALPN is required to enable
15004 HTTP/2 on an HTTPS frontend and HTTP/3 on a QUIC frontend. However, when such
15005 frontends have none of "npn", "alpn" and "no-alpn" set, a default value of
15006 "h2,http/1.1" will be used for a regular HTTPS frontend, and "h3" for a QUIC
15007 frontend. Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only
15008 supposed the now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most
15009 browsers still support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may
15010 still work for a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. Protocols
15011 not advertised are not negotiated. For example it is possible to only accept
15012 HTTP/2 connections with this:
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010015013
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015014 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2 # explicitly disable HTTP/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015015
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020015016 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
15017 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015018 Each "alpn" statement will replace a previous one. In order to remove them,
15019 use "no-alpn".
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020015020
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015021 Note that some old browsers such as Firefox 88 used to experience issues with
15022 WebSocket over H2, and in case such a setup is encountered, it may be needed
15023 to either explicitly disable HTTP/2 in the "alpn" string by forcing it to
15024 "http/1.1" or "no-alpn", or to enable "h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients"
15025 globally.
15026
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015027backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010015028 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015029 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
15030
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015031ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015032 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15033 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015034 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15035 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015036 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015037
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020015038 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
15039 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
15040 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
15041 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
15042 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050015043 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020015044
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015045ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
15046 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
15047 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010015048 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
15049 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
15050 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
15051 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
15052 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015053 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
15054 error is ignored.
15055
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015056ca-sign-file <cafile>
15057 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15058 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
15059 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
15060 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
15061 'generate-certificates' for details.
15062
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000015063ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015064 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
15065 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
15066 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
15067 'generate-certificates' for details.
15068
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010015069ca-verify-file <cafile>
15070 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
15071 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
15072 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
15073 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
15074 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
15075
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015076ciphers <ciphers>
15077 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15078 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000015079 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015080 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015081 information and recommendations see e.g.
15082 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
15083 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
15084 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
15085
15086ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
15087 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
15088 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +010015089 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
15090 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
15091 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
15092 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
15093 This setting might accept TLSv1.2 ciphersuites however this is an
15094 undocumented behavior and not recommended as it could be inconsistent or buggy.
15095 The default TLSv1.3 ciphersuites of OpenSSL are:
15096 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
15097
15098 TLSv1.3 only supports 5 ciphersuites:
15099
15100 - TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
15101 - TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
15102 - TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256
15103 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_SHA256
15104 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_8_SHA256
15105
15106 Example:
15107 ciphers ECDHE-RSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384:ECDHE-RSA-CHACHA20-POLY1305:ECDHE-RSA-AES128-GCM-SHA256
15108 ciphersuites TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015109
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +020015110client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
15111 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15112 the string describing the list of signature algorithms related to client
15113 authentication that are negotiated . The format of the string is defined in
15114 "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
15115 recommended to use this setting if no specific usecase was identified.
15116
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015117crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015118 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15119 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020015120 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
15121 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015122
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015123crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015124 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15125 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
15126 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
15127 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
15128 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010015129 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
15130 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015131
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010015132 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
15133 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
15134
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015135 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
15136 are loaded.
15137
15138 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010015139 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020015140 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
15141 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
15142 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
15143 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
15144 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
15145 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
15146 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015147 www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used, HAProxy will not start
15148 unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015149
15150 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
15151 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
15152 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
15153 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010015154 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
15155 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015156
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020015157 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015158
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015159 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015160 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015161 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
15162 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015163 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
15164 clients).
15165
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015166 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015167 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
15168 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
15169 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
15170 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
15171 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
15172 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
15173 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
15174 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
15175 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
15176 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
15177 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
15178 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
15179
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015180 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010015181 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
15182 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
15183 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
15184 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
15185
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050015186 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
15187 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
15188 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
15189 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015190
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015191 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
15192 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
15193 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015194
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015195crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015196 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010015197 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
15198 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
15199 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
15200 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
15201 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
15202 in new version of OpenSSL.
15203 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
15204 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015205
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015206crt-list <file>
15207 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015208 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
15209 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015210
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015211 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
15212
William Lallemandb5a3d582024-05-21 17:49:58 +020015213 sslbindconf supports the following keywords from the bind line
15214 (see Section 5.1. Bind options):
15215
15216 - allow-0rtt
15217 - alpn
15218 - ca-file
15219 - ca-verify-file
15220 - ciphers
15221 - ciphersuites
15222 - client-sigalgs
15223 - crl-file
15224 - curves
15225 - ecdhe
15226 - no-alpn
15227 - no-ca-names
15228 - npn
15229 - sigalgs
15230 - ssl-min-ver
15231 - ssl-max-ver
15232 - verify
15233
15234 It overrides the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015235
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015236 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015237 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
15238 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
15239 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
15240 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
15241 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015242 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
15243 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
15244 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015245
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015246 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
15247 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
15248 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015249
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015250 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
15251
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015252 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015253 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015254 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
15255 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
15256 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
15257 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
15258 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
15259 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015260
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015261 When no ALPN is set, the "bind" line's default one is used. If a "bind" line
15262 has no "no-alpn", "alpn" nor "npn" set, a default value will be used
15263 depending on the protocol (see "alpn" above). However if the "bind" line has
15264 a different default, or explicitly disables ALPN using "no-alpn", it is
15265 possible to force a specific value for a certificate.
15266
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015267 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015268 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015269 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015270 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015271 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015272 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015273
William Lallemand5d9ab402024-06-18 12:08:19 +020015274curves <curves>
15275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15276 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
15277 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
15278 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
15279 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
15280 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
15281
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015282defer-accept
15283 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15284 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
15285 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015286 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015287 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
15288 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
15289 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
15290 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
15291 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
15292 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
15293 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
15294
William Lallemand5d9ab402024-06-18 12:08:19 +020015295ecdhe <named curve>
15296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15297 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
15298 used named curve is prime256v1.
15299
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015300expose-fd listeners
15301 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
15302 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010015303 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
15304 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015305 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015306
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015307force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015308 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015309 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015310 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015311 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015312
15313force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015314 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015315 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015316 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015317
15318force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015319 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015320 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015321 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015322
15323force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015324 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015325 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015326 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015327
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015328force-tlsv13
15329 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
15330 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015331 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015332
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015333generate-certificates
15334 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15335 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
15336 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
15337 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
15338 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
15339 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
15340 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
15341 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
15342 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
15343 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
15344 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
15345
15346 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
15347 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015348 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015349 certificate is used many times.
15350
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015351gid <gid>
15352 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
15353 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15354 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
15355 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
15356 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15357
15358group <group>
15359 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
15360 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
15361 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
15362 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
15363 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15364
15365id <id>
15366 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
15367 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
15368 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
15369 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
15370
15371interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010015372 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
15373 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
15374 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
15375 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
15376 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
15377 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010015378 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
15379 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
15380 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
15381 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
15382 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
15383 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015384
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015385level <level>
15386 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
15387 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
15388 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015389 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015390 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
15391 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
15392 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015393 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015394 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015395 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015396 all counters).
15397
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015398maxconn <maxconn>
15399 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
15400 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
15401 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
15402 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
15403 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
15404 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
15405 eat all memory.
15406
15407mode <mode>
15408 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
15409 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
15410 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
15411 UNIX sockets.
15412
15413mss <maxseg>
15414 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
15415 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
15416 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
15417 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
15418 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
15419 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
15420 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
15421 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
15422 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
15423 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
15424 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
15425
15426name <name>
15427 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
15428 page.
15429
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015430namespace <name>
15431 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15432 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
15433 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15434 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15435
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015436nice <nice>
15437 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
15438 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
15439 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
15440 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
15441 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
15442 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
15443 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
15444 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
15445 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
15446 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
15447 one for an RDP socket.
15448
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015449no-alpn
15450 Disables ALPN processing (technically speaking this sets the ALPN string to
15451 an empty string that will not be advertised). It permits to cancel a previous
15452 occurrence of an "alpn" setting and to disable application protocol
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015453 negotiation. It may also be used to prevent a listener from negotiating ALPN
15454 with a client on an HTTPS or QUIC listener; by default, HTTPS listeners will
15455 advertise "h2,http/1.1" and QUIC listeners will advertise "h3". See also
15456 "alpn" bove. Note that when using "crt-list", a certificate may override the
15457 "alpn" setting and re-enable its processing.
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015458
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015459no-ca-names
15460 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15461 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010015462 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015463
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015464no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015465 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015466 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015467 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015468 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015469 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
15470 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015471
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015472no-tls-tickets
15473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15474 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15475 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015476 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
15477 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015478 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15479 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15480 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015481
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015482no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015484 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015485 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015486 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015487 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15488 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015489
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015490no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015492 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015493 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015494 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015495 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15496 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015497
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015498no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015499 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015500 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015501 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015502 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015503 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15504 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015505
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015506no-tlsv13
15507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15508 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
15509 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
15510 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015511 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15512 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015513
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015514npn <protocols>
15515 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15516 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15517 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015518 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015519 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010015520 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15521 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
15522 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
15523 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
15524 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015525
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015526ocsp-update [ off | on ] (crt-list only)
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015527 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
15528 Its value defaults to 'off'.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015529 Please note that for now, this option can only be used in a crt-list line, it
15530 cannot be used directly on a bind line. It lies in this "Bind options"
15531 section because it is still a frontend option. This limitation was set so
15532 that the option applies to only one certificate at a time.
15533 If a given certificate is used in multiple crt-lists with different values of
15534 the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be raised. Here is an example
15535 configuration enabling it:
15536
15537 haproxy.cfg:
15538 frontend fe
15539 bind :443 ssl crt-list haproxy.list
15540
15541 haproxy.list:
15542 server_cert.pem [ocsp-update on] foo.bar
15543
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015544 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
15545 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
15546 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
15547 the OCSP certid to be built.
15548 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
15549 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
15550 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
15551 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
15552 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
15553 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
15554 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
15555 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
15556 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
15557 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
15558 short time after init.
15559 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
15560 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015561 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init.
15562 The default minimum and maximum delays (5 minutes and 1 hour respectively)
15563 can be configured by the "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay" and
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +010015564 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay" global options.
15565
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015566 Whenever an OCSP response is updated by the auto update task or following a
15567 call to the "update ssl ocsp-response" CLI command, a dedicated log line is
15568 emitted. It follows a dedicated log-format that contains the following header
15569 "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft" and is followed by specific OCSP-related information:
15570 - the path of the corresponding frontend certificate
15571 - a numerical update status
15572 - a textual update status
15573 - the number of update failures for the given response
15574 - the number of update successes for the givan response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb33fe2f2023-02-28 17:46:25 +010015575 See "show ssl ocsp-updates" CLI command for a full list of error codes and
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015576 error messages. This line is emitted regardless of the success or failure of
15577 the concerned OCSP response update.
15578 The OCSP request/response is sent and received through an http_client
15579 instance that has the dontlog-normal option set and that uses the regular
15580 HTTP log format in case of error (unreachable OCSP responder for instance).
15581 If such an error occurs, another log line that contains HTTP-related
15582 information will then be emitted alongside the "regular" OCSP one (which will
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015583 likely have "HTTP error" as text status). But if a purely HTTP error happens
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015584 (unreachable OCSP responder for instance), an extra log line that follows the
15585 regular HTTP log-format will be emitted.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015586 Here are two examples of such log lines, with a successful OCSP update log
15587 line first and then an example of an HTTP error with the two different lines
15588 (lines were spit and the URL was shortened for readability):
15589 <134>Mar 6 11:16:53 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:16:52.808] \
15590 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/foo.pem 1 "Update successful" 0 1
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015591
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015592 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:54.207] \
15593 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/bar.pem 2 "HTTP error" 1 0
15594 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:52.200] \
15595 <OCSP-UPDATE> -/- 2/0/-1/-1/3009 503 217 - - SC-- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0 {} \
15596 "GET http://127.0.0.1:12345/MEMwQT HTTP/1.1"
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015597
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015598 Troubleshooting:
15599 A common error that can happen with let's encrypt certificates is if the DNS
15600 resolution provides an IPv6 address and your system does not have a valid
15601 outgoing IPv6 route. In such a case, you can either create the appropriate
15602 route or set the "httpclient.resolvers.prefer ipv4" option in the global
15603 section.
15604 In case of "OCSP response check failure" error, you might want to check that
15605 the issuer certificate that you provided is valid.
15606
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015607prefer-client-ciphers
15608 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
15609 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
15610 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020015611 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
15612 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
15613 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015614
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015615proto <name>
15616 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
15617 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
15618 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015619 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
15620 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15621
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015622 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15623 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15624 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015625
15626 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15627 a bind line :
15628
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015629 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015630 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15631 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15632
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015633 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015634 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080015635 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015636 h2" on the bind line.
15637
Frédéric Lécaille7e491d62023-11-13 18:11:11 +010015638quic-cc-algo { cubic | newreno }
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020015639 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
15640 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
15641 to those used by TCP.
15642
15643 Default value: cubic
15644
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015645quic-force-retry
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015646 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
15647 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
15648 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
15649 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
15650 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
15651 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
15652 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010015653 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
15654
15655 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
15656 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015657
15658 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
15659 information about QUIC retry.
15660
William Lallemand5d9ab402024-06-18 12:08:19 +020015661severity-output <format>
15662 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
15663 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
15664 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
15665 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
15666 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
15667 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
15668 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
15669 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
15670 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
15671 rfc5424 convention.
15672
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015673shards <number> | by-thread | by-group
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015674 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
15675 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
15676 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
15677 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
15678 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
15679 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
15680 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
15681 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
15682 little bit.
15683
15684 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
15685 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
15686 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
15687 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
15688 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015689 is an integral divisor of the number of threads. Alternately, the other
15690 special value "by-group" will create one shard per thread group. This can
15691 be useful when dealing with many threads and not wanting to create too many
15692 sockets. The load distribution will be a bit less optimal but the contention
15693 (especially in the system) will still be lower than with a single socket.
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015694
Willy Tarreauc1fbdd62023-04-22 11:38:55 +020015695 On operating systems that do not support multiple sockets bound to the same
15696 address, "by-thread" and "by-group" will automatically fall back to a single
15697 shard. For "by-group" this is done without any warning since it doesn't
15698 change anything for a single group, and will result in sockets being
15699 duplicated for each group anyway. However, for "by-thread", a diagnostic
15700 warning will be emitted if this happens since the resulting number of
15701 listeners will not be the expected one.
15702
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +020015703sigalgs <sigalgs>
15704 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15705 the string describing the list of signature algorithms that are negotiated
15706 during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined
15707 in "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
15708 recommended to use this setting unless compatibility with a middlebox is
15709 required.
15710
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015711ssl
15712 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015713 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015714 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
15715 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020015716 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
15717 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015718
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015719ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15720 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015721 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
15722 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
15723 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015724 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15725
15726ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015727 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
15728 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
15729 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
15730 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015731
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015732strict-sni
15733 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
15734 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015735 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
15736 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
15737 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
15738 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
15739 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015740
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015741tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015742 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015743 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015744 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015745 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015746 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
15747 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
15748 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
15749 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
15750 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
15751 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
15752 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15753
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015754tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010015755 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015756 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
15757 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
15758 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
15759 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
15760 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
15761 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
15762 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020015763 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
15764 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
15765 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015766
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015767thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>[,...]
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015768 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
15769 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
15770 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015771
15772 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
15773 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015774 It is also possible to designate a thread number using its relative number
15775 inside its thread group, by specifying the thread group number first, then a
15776 slash ('/') and the relative thread number(s). In this case thread numbers
15777 also start at 1 and end at 32 or 64 depending on the platform. When absolute
15778 thread numbers are specified, they will be automatically translated to
15779 relative numbers once thread groups are known. Usually, absolute numbers are
15780 preferred for simple configurations, and relative ones are preferred for
15781 complex configurations where CPU arrangement matters for performance.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015782
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015783 After the optional thread group number, the "thread-set" specification must
15784 use the following format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015785
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015786 "all" | "odd" | "even" | [number][-[number]]
15787
15788 As their names imply, "all" validates all threads within the set (either all
15789 of the group's when a group is specified, or all of the process' threads),
15790 "odd" validates all odd-numberred threads (every other thread starting at 1)
15791 either for the process or the group, and "even" validates all even-numberred
15792 threads (every other thread starting at 2). If instead thread number ranges
15793 are used, then all threads included in the range from the first to the last
15794 thread number are validated. The numbers are either relative to the group
Willy Tarreau7fd87562023-02-28 08:19:37 +010015795 or absolute depending on the presence of a thread group number. If the first
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015796 thread number is omitted, "1" is used, representing either the first thread
15797 of the group or the first thread of the process. If the last thread number is
15798 omitted, either the last thread number of the group (32 or 64) is used, or
15799 the last thread number of the process (global.nbthread).
15800
15801 These ranges may be repeated and delimited by a comma, so that non-contiguous
15802 thread sets can be specified, and the group, if present, must be specified
15803 again for each new range. Note that it is not permitted to mix group-relative
15804 and absolute specifications because the whole "bind" line must use either
15805 an absolute notation or a relative one, as those not set will be resolved at
15806 the end of the parsing.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015807
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015808 It is important to know that each listener described by a "bind" line creates
15809 at least one socket represented by at least one file descriptor. Since file
15810 descriptors cannot span multiple thread groups, if a "bind" line specifies a
15811 thread range that covers more than one group, several file descriptors will
15812 automatically be created so that there is at least one per group. Technically
15813 speaking they all refer to the same socket in the kernel, but they will get a
15814 distinct identifier in haproxy and will even have a dedicated stats entry if
15815 "option socket-stats" is used.
15816
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015817 The main purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but
15818 not the same thread in a listener, so that the system can distribute the
15819 incoming connections into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue
15820 load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015821 See also the "shards" keyword above that automates duplication of "bind"
15822 lines and their assignment to multiple groups of threads.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015823
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015824tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
15825 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010015826 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
15827 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
15828 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
15829 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
15830 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
15831 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
15832 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
15833 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
15834 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
15835 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015836 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
15837 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
15838
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015839transparent
15840 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15841 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
15842 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
15843 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
15844 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
15845 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
15846 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
15847 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
15848 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
15849 so check for support with your vendor.
15850
15851uid <uid>
15852 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
15853 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15854 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
15855 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
15856 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15857
15858user <user>
15859 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
15860 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15861 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
15862 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
15863 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15864
William Lallemand5d9ab402024-06-18 12:08:19 +020015865v4v6
15866 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15867 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
15868 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
15869 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
15870 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
15871
15872v6only
15873 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15874 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
15875 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
15876 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
15877 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
15878
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015879verify [none|optional|required]
15880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
15881 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
15882 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
15883 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
15884 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015885 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
15886 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
15887 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
15888 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020015889
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200158905.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015891------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015893The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
15894which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
15895arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
15896settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
15897after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
15898Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
15899address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015901 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015902 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015903
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015904Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
15905keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
15906
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015907The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015908
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015909addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015910 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010015911 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15912 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
15913 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
15914 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
15915 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015916
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015917agent-check
15918 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015919 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010015920 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
15921 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
15922 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015923
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015924 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015925 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015926 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020015927 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
15928 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015929
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015930 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
15931 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
15932 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
15933 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
15934 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020015935
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015936 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015937 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015938
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015939 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15940 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
15941 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015942
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015943 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15944 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
15945 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015946
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020015947 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015948 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
15949 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
15950 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
15951 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015952 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015953 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015954
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015955 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
15956 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015957
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015958 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
15959 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
15960 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
15961 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
15962 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
15963 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
15964 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
15965 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
15966 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015967
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015968 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
15969 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015970 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
15971 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
15972 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010015973 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015974
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015975 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015976 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015977
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015978agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015979 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015980 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15981 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15982 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15983 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15984
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015985agent-inter <delay>
15986 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15987 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15988
15989 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15990 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15991 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15992 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15993 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15994 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15995 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15996 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15997 of backends use the same servers.
15998
15999 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
16000
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010016001agent-addr <addr>
16002 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
16003
16004 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016005 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010016006 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
16007 hostname, it will be resolved.
16008
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090016009agent-port <port>
16010 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
16011
16012 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
16013
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020016014allow-0rtt
16015 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020016016 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
16017 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020016018
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016019alpn <protocols>
16020 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
16021 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
16022 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016023 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016024 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
16025 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
16026 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
16027 now obsolete NPN extension.
16028 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
16029 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
16030
16031 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
16032
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016033 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
16034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016035backup
16036 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
16037 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
16038 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
16039 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016040 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
16041 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016042
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016043ca-file <cafile>
16044 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16045 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020016046 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
16047 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020016048 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020016049
16050 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
16051 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
16052 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016054check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020016055 This option enables health checks on a server:
16056 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
16057 considered available.
16058 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
16059 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
16060 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
16061 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
16062 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010016063 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
16064 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020016065 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
16066 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
16067 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
16068 exchanges succeed.
16069
16070 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
16071 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
16072 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
16073 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
16074 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050016075 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020016076 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
16077
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010016078 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020016079 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010016080 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
16081 not overridden.
16082
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020016083 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
16084 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
16085
16086 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
16087 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
16088
16089 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
16090 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
16091 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
16092 available.
16093
16094 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
16095 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
16096 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
16097
16098 Example:
16099 # simple tcp check
16100 backend foo
16101 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
16102 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
16103 backend foo
16104 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
16105 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
16106 backend foo
16107 option tcp-check
16108 tcp-check connect
16109 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016110
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020016111check-send-proxy
16112 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
16113 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
16114 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
16115 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
16116 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
16117 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
16118 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
16119
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010016120check-alpn <protocols>
16121 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
16122 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
16123 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
16124
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020016125check-proto <name>
16126 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
16127 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
16128 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016129 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
16130 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
16131
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016132 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
16133 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
16134 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016135
16136 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
16137 directive on a server line:
16138
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016139 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016140 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
16141 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
16142 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
16143
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016144 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020016145 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
16146 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
16147
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010016148check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020016149 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010016150 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
16151 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020016152
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016153check-ssl
16154 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
16155 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
16156 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
16157 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016158 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016159 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
16160 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016161 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016162 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
16163 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016164
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016165check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016166 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016167 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
16168 for normal traffic.
16169
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016170ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016171 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
16172 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
16173 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000016174 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
16175 information and recommendations see e.g.
16176 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
16177 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
16178 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016179
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016180ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
16181 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
16182 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +010016183 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
16184 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
16185 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
16186 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
16187 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016189cookie <value>
16190 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
16191 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
16192 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
16193 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
16194 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
16195 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
16196 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
16197
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016198crl-file <crlfile>
16199 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16200 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
16201 to verify server's certificate.
16202
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020016203crt <cert>
16204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
16205 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
16206 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
16207 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
16208 certificate request.
16209
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020016210 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
16211 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
16212 option is set accordingly).
16213
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016214disabled
16215 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
16216 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
16217 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
16218 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
16219 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016220 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016221
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016222enabled
16223 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
16224 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
16225 default value.
16226 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
16227 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016228
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016229error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010016230 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
16231 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
16232 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016233
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016234 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016236fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016237 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
16238 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
16239 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
16240
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016241force-sslv3
16242 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16243 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016244 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016245 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016246
16247force-tlsv10
16248 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016249 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016250 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016251
16252force-tlsv11
16253 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016254 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016255 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016256
16257force-tlsv12
16258 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016259 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016260 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016261
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016262force-tlsv13
16263 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16264 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016265 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016267id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020016268 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
16269 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
16270 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016271
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016272init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
16273 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
16274 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016275 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016276 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
16277 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
16278 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
16279 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
16280 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
16281 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
16282 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
16283 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
16284 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016285 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016286 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
16287 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
16288 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
16289 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
16290 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
16291 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016292 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016293
16294 Example:
16295 defaults
16296 # never fail on address resolution
16297 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
16298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016299inter <delay>
16300fastinter <delay>
16301downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016302 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
16303 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
16304 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
16305 between checks depending on the server state :
16306
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020016307 Server state | Interval used
16308 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16309 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
16310 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16311 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
16312 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
16313 or yet unchecked. |
16314 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16315 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
16316 | "inter" otherwise.
16317 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016319 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
16320 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
16321 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
16322 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090016323 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
16324 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
16325 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
16326 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
16327 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016328
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020016329log-proto <logproto>
16330 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
16331 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
16332 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
16333 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
16334
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016335maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016336 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
16337 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016338 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
16339 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016340 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
16341 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
16342 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
16343 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
16344
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016345 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
16346 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
16347 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
16348 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
16349 than 50 concurrent requests.
16350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016351maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016352 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
16353 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
16354 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
16355 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020016356 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
16357 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
16358 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
16359 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
16360 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
16361 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
16362 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016363
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010016364max-reuse <count>
16365 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
16366 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
16367 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
16368 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
16369 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
16370 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
16371 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
16372 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
16373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016374minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016375 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
16376 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
16377 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
16378 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
16379 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
16380 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016381 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016382 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016383
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020016384namespace <name>
16385 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
16386 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
16387 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
16388 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
16389
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016390no-agent-check
16391 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
16392 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16393 default value.
16394 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16395 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
16396
16397no-backup
16398 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
16399 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16400 default value.
16401 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16402 "default-server" "backup" setting.
16403
16404no-check
16405 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
16406 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16407 default value.
16408 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16409 "default-server" "check" setting.
16410
16411no-check-ssl
16412 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
16413 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16414 default value.
16415 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16416 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
16417
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016418no-send-proxy
16419 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
16420 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16421 default value.
16422 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16423 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
16424
16425no-send-proxy-v2
16426 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
16427 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16428 default value.
16429 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16430 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
16431
16432no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
16433 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
16434 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16435 default value.
16436 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16437 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
16438
16439no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16440 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
16441 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16442 default value.
16443 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16444 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
16445
16446no-ssl
16447 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
16448 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16449 default value.
16450 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16451 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
16452
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010016453 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
16454 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
16455 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
16456
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010016457no-ssl-reuse
16458 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
16459 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
16460 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
16461 and for paranoid users.
16462
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016463no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016464 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16465 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016466 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016467
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016468 Supported in default-server: No
16469
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016470no-tls-tickets
16471 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16472 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
16473 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016474 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
16475 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016476 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16477 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16478 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016479 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016480
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016481no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016482 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016483 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16484 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016485 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16486 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016487 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016488
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016489 Supported in default-server: No
16490
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016491no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016492 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016493 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16494 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016495 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16496 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016497 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016498
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016499 Supported in default-server: No
16500
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016501no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016502 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016503 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16504 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016505 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16506 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016507 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016508
16509 Supported in default-server: No
16510
16511no-tlsv13
16512 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16513 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16514 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
16515 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16516 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016517 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016518
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016519 Supported in default-server: No
16520
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016521no-verifyhost
16522 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
16523 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16524 default value.
16525 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16526 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016527
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016528no-tfo
16529 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
16530 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16531 default value.
16532 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16533 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
16534
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090016535non-stick
16536 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
16537 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
16538 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
16539
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016540npn <protocols>
16541 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
16542 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
16543 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016544 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016545 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
16546 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
16547 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
16548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016549observe <mode>
16550 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
16551 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
16552 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
16553 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
16554 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
16555 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010016556 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016557
16558 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
16559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016560on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016561 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
16562 Currently, four modes are available:
16563 - fastinter: force fastinter
16564 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
16565 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
16566 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
16567 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
16568
16569 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
16570
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016571on-marked-down <action>
16572 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
16573 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016574 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
16575 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
16576 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
16577 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
16578 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
16579 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
16580 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
16581 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016582
16583 Actions are disabled by default
16584
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016585on-marked-up <action>
16586 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
16587 Currently one action is available:
16588 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
16589 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
16590 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
16591 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016592 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
16593 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016594 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
16595 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
16596
16597 Actions are disabled by default
16598
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016599pool-low-conn <max>
16600 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
16601 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
16602 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
16603 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
16604 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
16605 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
16606 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
16607 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
16608 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
16609 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010016610 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
16611 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
16612 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
16613 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016614
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010016615pool-max-conn <max>
16616 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
16617 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
16618 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
16619 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
16620 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
16621 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
16622
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016623pool-purge-delay <delay>
16624 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010016625 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020016626 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016628port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016629 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010016630 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
16631 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
16632 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
16633 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
16634 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016635
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016636proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016637 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
16638 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
16639 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016640 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
16641 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
16642
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016643 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
16644 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
16645 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016646
16647 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
16648 a server line :
16649
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016650 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016651 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
16652 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
16653 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
16654
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016655 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016656 protocol for all connections established to this server.
16657
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016658 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
16659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016660redir <prefix>
16661 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
16662 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
16663 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
16664 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
16665 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
16666 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
16667 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
16668 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016669 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016670 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016671 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
16672 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
16673 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
16674 loop between the client and HAProxy!
16675
16676 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
16677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016678rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016679 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
16680 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
16681 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
16682
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016683resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
16684 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
16685 server.
16686
16687 Available options:
16688
16689 * allow-dup-ip
16690 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
16691 resolution at runtime is in operation.
16692 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
16693 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
16694 For such case, simply enable this option.
16695 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
16696
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050016697 * ignore-weight
16698 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
16699 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
16700 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
16701
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016702 * prevent-dup-ip
16703 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
16704 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
16705 same fqdn.
16706 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
16707
16708 Example:
16709 backend b_myapp
16710 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
16711 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16712 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16713
16714 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
16715 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
16716 it
16717 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
16718 different address
16719
16720 Default value: not set
16721
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016722resolve-prefer <family>
16723 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
16724 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
16725 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
16726 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
16727
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020016728 Default value: ipv6
16729
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016730 Example:
16731
16732 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016733
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016734resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016735 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016736 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016737 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016738 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
16739 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016740 configured network, another address is selected.
16741
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016742 Example:
16743
16744 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016745
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016746resolvers <id>
16747 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
16748 hostname.
16749
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016750 Example:
16751
16752 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016753
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016754 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016755
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016756send-proxy
16757 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
16758 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
16759 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
16760 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016761 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
16762 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
16763 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
16764 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016765 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016766 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
16767 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
16768 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
16769 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
16770 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016771 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
16772 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016773
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016774send-proxy-v2
16775 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
16776 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16777 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16778 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020016779 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
16780 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
16781 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
16782 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016783
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016784proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010016785 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
16786 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
16787
16788 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
16789 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
16790 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
16791 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
16792 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
16793 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
16794 connection is supported).
16795 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
16796 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
16797 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
16798 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
16799 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
16800 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
16801 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016802
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016803send-proxy-v2-ssl
16804 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16805 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16806 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16807 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16808 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16809 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
16810 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016811 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
16812 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016813
16814send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16815 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16816 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16817 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16818 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16819 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16820 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
16821 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
16822 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016823 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
16824 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016825
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020016826shard <shard>
16827 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
16828 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
16829 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
16830 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
16831 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
16832 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
16833 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
16834
16835 Example :
16836
16837 peers mypeers
16838 shards 3
16839 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
16840 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
16841 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
16842 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
16843
16844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016845slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016846 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
16847 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
16848 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
16849 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
16850 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
16851 parameters :
16852
16853 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
16854 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
16855
16856 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
16857 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
16858 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
16859 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
16860
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016861 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016862 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
16863 seen as failed.
16864
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016865sni <expression>
16866 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
16867 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
16868 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010016869 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
16870 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
16871 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
16872 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020016873 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016874 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010016875 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
16876 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016877
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016878source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020016879source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016880source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016881 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
16882 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
16883 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
16884 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
16885
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016886 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
16887 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
16888 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
16889 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
16890 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
16891 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
16892 server.
16893
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000016894 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
16895 specifying the source address without port(s).
16896
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016897ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020016898 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
16899 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
16900 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
16901 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
16902 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
16903 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016904 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
16905 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016906
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016907ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16908 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
16909 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16910 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
16911
16912ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16913 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
16914 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16915 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
16916
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016917ssl-reuse
16918 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
16919 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16920 default value.
16921 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16922 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
16923
16924stick
16925 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
16926 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16927 default value.
16928 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16929 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016930
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016931socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016932 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016933 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
16934 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
16935
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016936tcp-ut <delay>
16937 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016938 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016939 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016940 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016941 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
16942 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
16943 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
16944 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
16945 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
16946 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
16947 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
16948 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
16949 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
16950
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016951tfo
16952 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
16953 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
16954 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
16955 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016956 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016957 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016958
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016959track [<backend>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020016960 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
16961 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
16962 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016963 enabled. If <backend> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016964 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
16965
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016966tls-tickets
16967 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
16968 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16969 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016970 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16971 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16972 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016973 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010016974 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016975
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016976verify [none|required]
16977 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016978 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016979 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16980 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016981 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016982 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16983 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16984 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16985 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16986 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16987 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16988 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16989 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016990
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016991verifyhost <hostname>
16992 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016993 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16994 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16995 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16996 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16997 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16998 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16999 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
17000 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070017001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010017002weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017003 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
17004 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
17005 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020017006 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
17007 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
17008 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
17009 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
17010 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
17011 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017012
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020017013ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
17014 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
17015 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
17016 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
17017
17018 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
17019 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
17020 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
17021 server ALPN contains it.
17022
17023 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
17024 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
17025 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
17026 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
17027
17028 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
17029 favor of the ALPN extension.
17030
17031 See also "alpn" and "proto".
17032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017033
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200170345.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
17035-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017036
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017037HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
17038using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070017039configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017040This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
17041can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
17042workload.
17043This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
17044resolution at run time.
17045Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
17046carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
17047
17048
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200170495.3.1. Global overview
17050----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017051
17052As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
17053different steps of the process life:
17054
17055 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
17056 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
17057 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
17058
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017059 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
17060 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017061
17062A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
17063 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
17064 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
17065 resolution to know this new IP.
17066
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017067When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017068HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017069SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
17070from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017071will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017072will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020017073
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017074A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017075 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017076 first valid response.
17077
17078 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
17079 servers return an error.
17080
17081
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200170825.3.2. The resolvers section
17083----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017084
17085This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017086HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
17087contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017088
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020017089At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
17090no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
17091default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
17092failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
17093
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017094When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
17095uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
17096is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
17097answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
17098
17099When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017100used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017101
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017102 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
17103 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
17104 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017105
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017106 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
17107 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017108
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010017109 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017110 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
17111 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017112
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017113For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
17114following scenarios are possible:
17115
17116 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
17117 ignored
17118
17119 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
17120 applied
17121
17122 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
17123 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
17124
17125 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
17126 retries the query with a new type
17127
17128 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
17129 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017130
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017131As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017132a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017133<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017134
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017135
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017136resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017137 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017138
17139A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
17140
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020017141accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017142 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017143 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020017144 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
17145 by RFC 6891)
17146
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010017147 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
17148 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
17149 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
17150 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
17151 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
17152 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020017153
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020017154nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
17155 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
17156 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
17157 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
17158 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
17159 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
17160 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
17161 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
17162 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
17163 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010017164 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
17165
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060017166parse-resolv-conf
17167 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
17168 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
17169 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
17170
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017171hold <status> <period>
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010017172 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
17173 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
17174 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
17175 counteract the just received invalid status.
17176
17177 <status> : last name resolution status.
17178 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
17179 status during the concluding period.
17180
17181 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
17182 status during the concluding period.
17183
17184 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
17185 valid status during the concluding period.
17186
17187 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
17188 valid status during the concluding period.
17189
17190 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
17191 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
17192 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
17193 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
17194 dynamic resolution of servers.
17195
17196 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
17197 records after an updated answer record is received. It
17198 applies to SRV records.
17199
17200 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
17201 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
17202 milliseconds by default.
17203
17204 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
17205 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
17206 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
17207 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
17208 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
17209
17210 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
17211 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
17212 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
17213 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
17214
17215 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
17216 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017217
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010017218 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017219
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017220resolve_retries <nb>
17221 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
17222 giving up.
17223 Default value: 3
17224
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017225 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
17226 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
17227 type.
17228
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017229timeout <event> <time>
17230 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
17231 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
17232 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017233 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
17234 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017235 Default value: 1s
17236 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017237 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017238 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017239 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
17240 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
17241
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020017242 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017243
17244 resolvers mydns
17245 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
17246 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020017247 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060017248 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017249 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017250 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017251 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010017252 hold other 30s
17253 hold refused 30s
17254 hold nx 30s
17255 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017256 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017257 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017258
17259
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200172606. Cache
17261---------
17262
17263HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17264(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17265RAM.
17266
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020017267The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
17268blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017269
17270If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17271independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17272when we try to allocate a new one.
17273
17274The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
17275
17276It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17277"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17278for more details.
17279
17280When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17281replaced by "<CACHE>".
17282
17283
172846.1. Limitation
17285----------------
17286
17287The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17288
17289- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010017290- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
17291 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
17292 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017293- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
17294- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010017295- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
17296 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
17297 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017298- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
17299 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010017300- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
17301 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
17302 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017303
17304- If the request is not a GET
17305- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
17306- If the request contains an Authorization header
17307
17308
173096.2. Setup
17310-----------
17311
17312To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17313the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17314
17315
173166.2.1. Cache section
17317---------------------
17318
17319cache <name>
17320 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17321 size of cache is mandatory.
17322
17323total-max-size <megabytes>
17324 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
17325 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
17326
17327max-object-size <bytes>
17328 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17329 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17330 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
17331
17332max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017333 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017334 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17335 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17336 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17337 default.
17338
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017339process-vary <on/off>
17340 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017341 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
17342 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
17343 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017344 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017345
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017346max-secondary-entries <number>
17347 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
17348 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
17349 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
17350
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017351
173526.2.2. Proxy section
17353---------------------
17354
17355http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17356 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17357 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17358 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17359 after this one.
17360
17361http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17362 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17363 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17364 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17365 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17366
17367
17368Example:
17369
17370 backend bck1
17371 mode http
17372
17373 http-request cache-use foobar
17374 http-response cache-store foobar
17375 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17376
17377 cache foobar
17378 total-max-size 4
17379 max-age 240
17380
17381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200173827. Using ACLs and fetching samples
17383----------------------------------
17384
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017385HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017386client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
17387The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
17388these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
17389but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
17390data called patterns.
17391
17392
173937.1. ACL basics
17394---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017395
17396The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
17397content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
17398from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
17399simple :
17400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017401 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017402 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017403 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
17404 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017406The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
17407adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017408
17409In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
17410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017411 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017412
17413This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
17414Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
17415and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017416an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
17417conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
17418as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
17419are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017420
17421ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
17422'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
17423which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
17424
17425There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
17426performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
17427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017428The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
17429specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
17430this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017431methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
17432ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433
17434Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
17435 - boolean
17436 - integer (signed or unsigned)
17437 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
17438 - string
17439 - data block
17440
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017441Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
17442converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
17443would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
17444The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
17445which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
17446
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017447Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
17448keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
17449fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
17450which are summarized in the table below :
17451
17452 +---------------------+-----------------+
17453 | Sample or converter | Default |
17454 | output type | matching method |
17455 +---------------------+-----------------+
17456 | boolean | bool |
17457 +---------------------+-----------------+
17458 | integer | int |
17459 +---------------------+-----------------+
17460 | ip | ip |
17461 +---------------------+-----------------+
17462 | string | str |
17463 +---------------------+-----------------+
17464 | binary | none, use "-m" |
17465 +---------------------+-----------------+
17466
17467Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
17468matching method, see below.
17469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017470The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
17471 - boolean
17472 - integer or integer range
17473 - IP address / network
17474 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
17475 - regular expression
17476 - hex block
17477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017478The following ACL flags are currently supported :
17479
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017480 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
17481 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017482 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017483 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017484 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017485 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017486 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
17487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017488The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
17489read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
17490if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
17491lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
17492will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
17493beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017494a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017495lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
17496exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
17497
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017498The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
17499parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
17500ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
17501a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
17502check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
17503
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017504The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
17505socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
17506file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
17507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017508Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
17509loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
17510
17511 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
17512
17513In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
17514the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
17515case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
17516as well.
17517
17518The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
17519sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
17520do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
17521methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
17522is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017523obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017524followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
17525default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
17526that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
17527string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
17528
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017529The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
17530By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
17531string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
17532resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017533server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017534waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017535flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
17536function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
17537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017538There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
17539sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
17540be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017541
17542 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
17543 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017544 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
17545 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
17546 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
17547 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017548
17549 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
17550 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017551 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017552
17553 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017554 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017555
17556 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017557 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017558
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017559 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017560 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
17561
17562 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
17563 binary or string samples.
17564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017565 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
17566 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017568 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
17569 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
17570 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017572 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
17573 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017575 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
17576 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017578 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
17579 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017581 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
17582 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017583 This may be used with binary or string samples.
17584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017585 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
17586 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
17587 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017588
17589For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
17590request, it is possible to do :
17591
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017592 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017593
17594In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
17595buffer, one would use the following acl :
17596
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017597 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017598
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017599On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
17600possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
17601
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017602 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017604All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
17605criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
17606method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010017607to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
17608usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
17609converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
17610method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
17611matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017612criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
17613the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017615If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017616the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
17617For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017619 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
17620 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
17621 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
17622 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017623
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017624
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017625The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
17626types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
17627combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
17628brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
17629default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017631 +-------------------------------------------------+
17632 | Input sample type |
17633 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017634 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017635 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17636 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
17637 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017638 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017639 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017640 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017641 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017642 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017643 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017644 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017645 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017646 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017647 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017648 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017649 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017650 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017651 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017652 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017653 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017654 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017655 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017656 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017657 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017658 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017659 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17660 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
17661 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017662
17663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176647.1.1. Matching booleans
17665------------------------
17666
17667In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
17668Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
17669When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
17670that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
17671
17672Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
17673return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
17674"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
17675
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176777.1.2. Matching integers
17678------------------------
17679
17680Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
17681enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
17682to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
17683
17684Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
17685matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
17686lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017687
17688For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
17689unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
17690representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
17691
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017692As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
17693two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
17694instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
17695ranges and operators.
17696
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017697For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017698operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
17699Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
17700of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017701
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017702Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017703
17704 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
17705 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
17706 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
17707 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
17708 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
17709
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017710For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017711
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017712 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017713
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017714This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
17715
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017716 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017717
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200177197.1.3. Matching strings
17720-----------------------
17721
17722String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
17723different forms :
17724
17725 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017726 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017727
17728 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017729 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017730
17731 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
17732 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17733
17734 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
17735 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17736
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017737 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17738 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
17739 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
17740 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
17741 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
17742 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017743
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017744 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17745 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
17746 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
17747 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
17748 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
17749 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
17750 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
17751 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
17752 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
17753 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
17754 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017755
17756String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
17757exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
17758characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
17759string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
17760to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017761before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017762
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010017763Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
17764(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
17765Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
17766
17767Example:
17768 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
17769 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
17770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200177727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
17773---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017774
17775Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
17776they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
17777possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
17778passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
17779the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017780the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
17781match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017782
17783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200177847.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
17785-------------------------------------
17786
17787It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
17788not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
17789a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
17790to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
17791digits may be used upper or lower case.
17792
17793Example :
17794 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017795 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017796
17797
177987.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
17799---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017800
17801IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
17802netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
17803within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010017804host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017805difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
17806at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
17807does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
17808parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017809
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020017810The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
17811abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
17812
17813 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17814 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
17815 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17816 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
17817 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
17818 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
17819 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
17820 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17821
17822Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
17823192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
17824
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020017825IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
17826Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
17827trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
17828IPv6 patterns.
17829
17830HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
17831following situations :
17832 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
17833 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
17834 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
17835 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
17836 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
17837 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
17838 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
17839 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
17840 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
17841 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
17842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017843
178447.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
17845----------------------------------
17846
17847Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
17848combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
17849
17850 - AND (implicit)
17851 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
17852 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017854A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017856 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017858Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
17859indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017861For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
17862"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
17863requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
17864is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
17865
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017866 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017867 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
17868 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
17869 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017870
17871To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
17872and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
17873
17874 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
17875 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
17876 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
17877 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
17878
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017879 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017880 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
17881 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
17882 use_backend www if host_www
17883
17884It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
17885expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
17886be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
17887the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
17888
17889 The following rule :
17890
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017891 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017892 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017893
17894 Can also be written that way :
17895
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017896 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017897
17898It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
17899to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
17900simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
17901sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
17902good use is the following :
17903
17904 With named ACLs :
17905
17906 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
17907 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
17908 monitor fail if site_dead
17909
17910 With anonymous ACLs :
17911
17912 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
17913
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017914See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
17915keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017916
17917
179187.3. Fetching samples
17919---------------------
17920
17921Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
17922against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
17923sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
17924ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
17925of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
17926available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
17927
17928This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
17929Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
17930compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
17931deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
17932
17933The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
17934matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
17935method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
17936indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
17937
17938As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
17939when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
17940mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
17941the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
17942ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
17943
17944Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
17945multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
17946when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017947incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
17948are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017949is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
17950all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
17951
17952Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
17953 - name
17954 - name(arg1)
17955 - name(arg1,arg2)
17956
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017957
179587.3.1. Converters
17959-----------------
17960
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017961Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
17962of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
17963is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
17964was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017965has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017966unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
17967
17968These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
17969sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
17970the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017971support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017972
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017973A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
17974support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
17975supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
17976(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
17977bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
17978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017979The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017980
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001798151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
17982 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17983 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17984 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
17985 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17986 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17987
17988 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017989 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
17990 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000017991 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
17992 frontend http-in
17993 bind *:8081
17994 default_backend servers
17995 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17996 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17997
Aurelien DARRAGON5c6f86f2022-12-30 16:23:08 +010017998rfc7239_is_valid
17999 Returns true if input header is RFC 7239 compliant header value and false
18000 otherwise.
18001
18002 Example:
18003 acl valid req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_is_valid
18004 #input: "for=127.0.0.1;proto=http"
18005 # output: TRUE
18006 #input: "proto=custom"
18007 # output: FALSE
18008
Aurelien DARRAGON6fb58b82022-12-30 16:37:03 +010018009rfc7239_field(<field>)
18010 Extracts a single field/parameter from RFC 7239 compliant header value input.
18011
18012 Supported fields are:
18013 - proto: either 'http' or 'https'
18014 - host: http compliant host
18015 - for: RFC7239 node
18016 - by: RFC7239 node
18017
18018 More info here:
18019 https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html#section-6
18020
18021 Example:
18022 # extract host field from forwarded header and store it in req.fhost var
18023 http-request set-var(req.fhost) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(host)
18024 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\""
18025 # output: "haproxy.org:80"
18026
18027 # extract for field from forwarded header and store it in req.ffor var
18028 http-request set-var(req.ffor) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for)
18029 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\";for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
18030 # output: "127.0.0.1:9999"
18031
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010018032rfc7239_n2nn
18033 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
18034 into its corresponding nodename final form:
18035 - ipv4 address
18036 - ipv6 address
18037 - 'unknown'
18038 - '_obfs' identifier
18039
18040 Example:
18041 # extract 'for' field from forwarded header, extract nodename from
18042 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnn
18043 http-request set-var(req.fnn) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for),rfc7239_n2nn
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020018044 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
18045 # output: 127.0.0.1 (ipv4)
18046 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
18047 # output: ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff (ipv6)
18048 #input: "_name:_port"
18049 # output: "_name" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010018050
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010018051rfc7239_n2np
18052 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
18053 into its corresponding nodeport final form:
18054 - unsigned integer
18055 - '_obfs' identifier
18056
18057 Example:
18058 # extract 'by' field from forwarded header, extract node port from
18059 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnp
18060 http-request set-var(req.fnp) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(by),rfc7239_n2np
Aurelien DARRAGON06d8aad2023-06-02 15:29:17 +020018061 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020018062 # output: 9999 (integer)
18063 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
18064 # output: 9998 (integer)
18065 #input: "_name:_port"
18066 # output: "_port" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010018067
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018068add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018069 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018070 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018071 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18072 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018073 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018074 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18075 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18076 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18077 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018078 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018079 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018080
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020018081add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
18082 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
18083 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
18084 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
18085 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
18086 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
18087 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
18088 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
18089 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
18090 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
18091 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
18092 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
18093 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
18094 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
18095 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
18096 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
18097 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
18098 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010018099 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
18100 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020018101
18102 Example:
18103 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
18104 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
18105 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
18106 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
18107
18108 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
18109 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
18110
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010018111aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
18112 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
18113 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
18114 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
18115 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
18116 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
18117 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
18118
18119 Example:
18120 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
18121 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
18122
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018123and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018124 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018125 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018126 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18127 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018128 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018129 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18130 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18131 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18132 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018133 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018134 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018135
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020018136b64dec
18137 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
18138 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018139 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
18140 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020018141
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020018142base64
18143 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018144 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018145 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
18146 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020018147
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020018148be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
18149 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
18150 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
18151 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
18152 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
18153 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
18154
18155 Example:
18156 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
18157 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
18158 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
18159 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
18160
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020018161be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
18162 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
18163 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
18164 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
18165 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
18166 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
18167 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
18168
18169 Example:
18170 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
18171 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
18172 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
18173 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
18174
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018175bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018176 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018177 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018178 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018179 presence of a flag).
18180
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010018181bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
18182 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
18183 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018184 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010018185
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018186concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
18187 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
18188 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
18189 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
18190 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
18191 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
18192 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
18193 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
18194 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
18195 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
18196 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018197 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040018198 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018199 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020018200 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
18201 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
18202 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018203
18204 Example:
18205 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
18206 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
18207 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018208 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020018209 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018210 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
18211
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018212cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018213 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
18214 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018215
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018216crc32([<avalanche>])
18217 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
18218 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18219 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18220 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18221 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18222 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
18223 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
18224 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
18225 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
18226 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018227 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
18228
18229crc32c([<avalanche>])
18230 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
18231 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18232 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18233 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
18234 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
18235 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
18236 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
18237 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018238
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020018239cut_crlf
18240 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
18241 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
18242 updated.
18243
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010018244da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018245 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
18246 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
18247 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
18248 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018249 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018250 configuration language.
18251
18252 Example:
18253 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018254 bind *:8881
18255 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000018256 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018257
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010018258debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
18259 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
18260 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
18261 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
18262 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
18263 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
18264 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
18265 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
18266 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
18267 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
18268 printable sample types.
18269
18270 Example:
18271 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020018272
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018273digest(<algorithm>)
18274 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
18275 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
18276
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018277 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018278 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18279
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018280div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018281 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18282 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018283 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018284 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
18285 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018286 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018287 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18288 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18289 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18290 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018291 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018292 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018293
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018294djb2([<avalanche>])
18295 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
18296 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18297 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18298 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18299 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18300 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18301 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018302 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
18303 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018304
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018305even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018306 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018307 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
18308
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018309field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18310 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
18311 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
18312 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
18313 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
18314 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
18315 fields.
18316
18317 Example :
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010018318 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(4,_) # <empty>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018319 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
18320 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18321 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
18322 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
18323 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010018324
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018325fix_is_valid
18326 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
18327 Information eXchange):
18328
18329 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
18330 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018331 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018332 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010018333 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018334 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
18335 checksum
18336
18337 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18338 the server can be parsed.
18339
18340 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
18341 message, false if not.
18342
18343 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
18344
18345 Example:
18346 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18347 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18348
18349fix_tag_value(<tag>)
18350 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
18351 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
18352 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
18353 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050018354 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018355 added.
18356
18357 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18358 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
18359 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
18360 fix_is_valid converter.
18361
18362 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
18363
18364 Example:
18365 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18366 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18367 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
18368 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
18369 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
18370
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018371hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018372 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018373 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018374 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018375 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010018376
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018377hex2i
18378 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018379 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018380
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020018381htonl
18382 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
18383 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
18384 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
18385 unsigned 32-bit integer.
18386
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018387hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018388 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
18389 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
18390 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
18391 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
18392
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018393 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018394 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18395
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018396host_only
18397 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
18398 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18399 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18400 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18401
18402 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
18403
18404 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
18405
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018406http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018407 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18408 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018409 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
18410 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
18411 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
18412 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
18413 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
18414 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
18415 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
18416 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018417
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018418iif(<true>,<false>)
18419 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
18420 string otherwise.
18421
18422 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020018423 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018424
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018425in_table(<table>)
18426 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18427 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
18428 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018429 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018430 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
18431
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018432ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018433 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018434 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018435 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
18436 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
18437 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
18438 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
18439 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018440
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018441json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018442 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018443 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018444 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018445 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
18446 of errors:
18447 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
18448 bytes, ...)
18449 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
18450 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
18451
18452 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
18453 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
18454 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
18455 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
18456 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
18457 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018458 - "ascii" : never fails;
18459 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
18460 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018461 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018462 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018463 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
18464 characters corresponding to the other errors.
18465
18466 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018467 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018468
18469 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018470 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018471 capture request header user-agent len 150
18472 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018473
18474 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
18475 GET / HTTP/1.0
18476 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
18477
18478 Output log:
18479 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
18480
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020018481json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
18482 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
18483 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
18484 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
18485 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
18486
18487 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
18488 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
18489
18490 Example:
18491 # get a integer value from the request body
18492 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
18493 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
18494
18495 # get a key with '.' in the name
18496 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
18497 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
18498
18499 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
18500 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
18501
18502 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
18503 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
18504
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020018505jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18506 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
18507 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
18508 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
18509 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18510 json_path and output_type parameters.
18511
18512 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18513 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18514
18515jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18516 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
18517 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
18518 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
18519 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18520 json_path and output_type parameters.
18521
18522 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18523 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18524
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018525jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
18526 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
18527 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018528 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018529 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
18530 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
18531 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
18532 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018533
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018534 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018535 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). All the
Remi Tricot-Le Bretoncca939e2023-08-10 16:11:27 +020018536 algorithms mentioned in section 3.1 of RFC7518 are managed (HS, ES, RS and PS
18537 with the 256, 384 or 512 key sizes, as well as the special "none" case).
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018538
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018539 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
18540 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
18541 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
18542 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
18543 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
18544 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018545 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018546 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
18547
18548 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
18549 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
18550 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
18551 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
18552 contents.
18553
18554 The possible return values are the following :
18555
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018556 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
18557 | ID | message |
18558 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018559 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018560 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018561 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018562 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018563 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
18564 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
18565 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018566 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018567
18568 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18569 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18570
18571 Example:
18572 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
18573 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
18574 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
18575 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
Aurelien DARRAGON4761b0d2023-05-26 14:29:58 +020018576 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) -m str "RS256" }
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018577 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
18578
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018579language(<value>[,<default>])
18580 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
18581 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
18582 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
18583 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
18584 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
18585 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
18586 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
18587 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
18588 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018589 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018590 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
18591 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018592
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018593 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018594
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018595 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
18596 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018597
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018598 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
18599 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
18600 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
18601 use_backend spanish if es
18602 use_backend french if fr
18603 use_backend english if en
18604 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018605
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010018606length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010018607 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
18608 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18609 type. The result is of type integer.
18610
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018611lower
18612 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
18613 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18614 type. The result is of type string.
18615
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018616ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
18617 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18618 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
18619 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18620 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18621 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18622 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
18623
18624 Example :
18625
18626 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018627 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018628 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18629
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020018630ltrim(<chars>)
18631 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
18632 representation of the input sample.
18633
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018634map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18635map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18636map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18637 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
18638 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
18639 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
18640 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
18641 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
18642 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
18643 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
18644 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018645
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018646 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
18647 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
18648 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018649
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018650 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018651 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018652
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018653 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
18654 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18655 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
18656 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020018657 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
18658 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018659 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
18660 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18661 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
18662 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18663 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
18664 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18665 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
18666 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080018667 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
18668 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18669 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018670 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18671 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
18672 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18673 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
18674 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018675
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010018676 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
18677 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
18678 the corresponding match text.
18679
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018680 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
18681 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
18682 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
18683 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
18684 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018685
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018686 Example :
18687
18688 # this is a comment and is ignored
18689 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
18690 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
18691 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
18692 | | | `---------- value
18693 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
18694 | `---------------------------- key
18695 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
18696
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018697mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018698 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18699 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018700 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018701 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018702 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018703 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18704 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18705 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18706 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018707 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018708 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018709
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018710mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018711 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
18712 <packettype>.
18713 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
18714 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
18715 from.
18716 Supported string and integers can be found here:
18717 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
18718 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
18719
18720 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
18721 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
18722 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
18723 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
18724
18725 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
18726 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
18727 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18728 packets only):
18729 17: Session Expiry Interval
18730 33: Receive Maximum
18731 39: Maximum Packet Size
18732 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18733 25: Request Response Information
18734 23: Request Problem Information
18735 21: Authentication Method
18736 22: Authentication Data
18737 18: Will Delay Interval
18738 1: Payload Format Indicator
18739 2: Message Expiry Interval
18740 3: Content Type
18741 8: Response Topic
18742 9: Correlation Data
18743 Not supported yet:
18744 38: User Property
18745
18746 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
18747 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18748 packets only):
18749 17: Session Expiry Interval
18750 33: Receive Maximum
18751 36: Maximum QoS
18752 37: Retain Available
18753 39: Maximum Packet Size
18754 18: Assigned Client Identifier
18755 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18756 31: Reason String
18757 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
18758 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
18759 42: Shared Subscription Available
18760 19: Server Keep Alive
18761 26: Response Information
18762 28: Server Reference
18763 21: Authentication Method
18764 22: Authentication Data
18765 Not supported yet:
18766 38: User Property
18767
18768 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18769 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18770 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18771 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18772
18773 Example:
18774
18775 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
18776 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18777 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
18778 if data_in_buffer
18779 # do the same as above
18780 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18781 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
18782 if data_in_buffer
18783
18784mqtt_is_valid
18785 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
18786
18787 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18788 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18789 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18790 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18791
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010018792 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
18793
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018794 Example:
18795
18796 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040018797 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018798
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018799mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018800 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020018801 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
18802 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018803 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018804 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018805 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018806 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18807 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18808 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18809 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018810 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018811 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018812
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010018813nbsrv
18814 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
18815 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
18816 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
18817 map lookup.
18818
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018819neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018820 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
18821 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
18822 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
18823 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018824
18825not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018826 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018827 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018828 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018829 absence of a flag).
18830
18831odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018832 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018833 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
18834
18835or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018836 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018837 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018838 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18839 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018840 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018841 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18842 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18843 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18844 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018845 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018846 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018847
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070018848param(<name>,[<delim>])
18849 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
18850 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
18851 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
18852 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
18853 a value of an empty string.
18854
18855 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
18856 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
18857 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
18858 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
18859
18860 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
18861 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
18862 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
18863 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
18864 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
18865 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
18866
18867 Example :
18868 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
18869 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
18870 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
18871 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
18872 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
18873
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018874port_only
18875 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
18876 returning its port.
18877 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18878 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18879 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18880
18881 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
18882
18883 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
18884
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018885protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
18886 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
18887 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
18888 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
18889 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
18890 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18891 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18892 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18893 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
18894 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
18895 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18896 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
18897
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010018898regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018899 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
18900 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
18901 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
18902 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
18903 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
18904 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
18905 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
18906 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
18907 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018908 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
18909 of characters with other ones.
18910
18911 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
18912 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
18913 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
18914 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
18915 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
18916 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018917
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018918 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018919
18920 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
18921 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
18922 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018923 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018924
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018925 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
18926 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
18927
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018928 # capture groups and backreferences
18929 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020018930 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018931 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
18932
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018933capture-req(<id>)
18934 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
18935 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18936
18937 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018938 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18939 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018940
18941capture-res(<id>)
18942 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
18943 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18944
18945 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018946 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18947 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018948
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020018949rtrim(<chars>)
18950 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
18951 of the input sample.
18952
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018953sdbm([<avalanche>])
18954 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
18955 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18956 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18957 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18958 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18959 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18960 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018961 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
18962 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018963
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018964secure_memcmp(<var>)
18965 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
18966 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
18967 match.
18968
18969 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
18970 performed in constant time.
18971
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018972 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018973 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18974
18975 Example :
18976
18977 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
18978 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
18979 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
18980 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
18981
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010018982set-var(<var>[,<cond>...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018983 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018984 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
18985 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
18986 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18987 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018988 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018989 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18990 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018991 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018992 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18993 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018994 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018995 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018996
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018997 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
18998 possible conditions :
18999 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
19000 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
19001 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
19002 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
19003 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
19004 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
19005 Checks if the input is empty or not.
19006 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
19007 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
19008 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
19009 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
19010 called on the variable.
19011 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
19012 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
19013 configuration parsing.
19014 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
19015 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
19016 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
19017 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
19018 true by default.
19019
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020019020sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020019021 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020019022 sample with length of 20 bytes.
19023
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020019024sha2([<bits>])
19025 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
19026 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
19027
19028 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
19029 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
19030
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019031 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020019032 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
19033
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020019034srv_queue
19035 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
19036 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
19037 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
19038 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
19039 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
19040
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020019041strcmp(<var>)
19042 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
19043 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
19044 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
19045 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
19046 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
19047 shorter).
19048
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020019049 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
19050 strings in constant time.
19051
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020019052 Example :
19053
19054 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
19055 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
19056 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
19057
19058
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019059sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019060 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
19061 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019062 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019063 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
19064 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019065 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019066 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19067 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019068 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019069 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19070 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019071 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019072 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019073
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019074table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
19075 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19076 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19077 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
19078 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
19079 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
19080 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
19081
19082
19083table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
19084 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19085 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19086 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
19087 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
19088 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
19089 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
19090
19091table_conn_cnt(<table>)
19092 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19093 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019094 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019095 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
19096 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19097
19098table_conn_cur(<table>)
19099 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19100 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19101 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
19102 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
19103 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
19104
19105table_conn_rate(<table>)
19106 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19107 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19108 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
19109 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
19110 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
19111
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020019112table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
19113 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
19114 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
19115 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
19116 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
19117 input sample in the designated table.
19118 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
19119
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019120table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
19121 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
19122 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
19123 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
19124 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
19125 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19126 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
19127 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
19128 data-type).
19129 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
19130
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019131table_gpt0(<table>)
19132 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19133 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
19134 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
19135 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
19136 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
19137
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019138table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
19139 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
19140 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19141 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
19142 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
19143 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
19144 between 0 and 99.
19145 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
19146 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19147 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19148 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
19149
19150table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
19151 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
19152 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19153 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
19154 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
19155 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
19156 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19157 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
19158 value 0.
19159 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
19160 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19161 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
19162
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019163table_gpc0(<table>)
19164 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19165 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19166 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
19167 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
19168 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
19169
19170table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
19171 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19172 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19173 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
19174 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
19175 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
19176 sample fetch keyword.
19177
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019178table_gpc1(<table>)
19179 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19180 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19181 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
19182 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
19183 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
19184
19185table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
19186 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19187 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19188 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
19189 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
19190 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
19191 sample fetch keyword.
19192
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019193table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
19194 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19195 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019196 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019197 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
19198 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19199
19200table_http_err_rate(<table>)
19201 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19202 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19203 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
19204 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
19205 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
19206 keyword.
19207
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019208table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
19209 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19210 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19211 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
19212 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19213 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19214
19215table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
19216 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19217 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19218 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
19219 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
19220 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
19221 keyword.
19222
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019223table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
19224 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19225 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019226 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019227 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19228 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19229
19230table_http_req_rate(<table>)
19231 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19232 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19233 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
19234 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
19235 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
19236 keyword.
19237
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010019238table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020019239 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
19240 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
19241 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
19242 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
19243 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
19244 updated.
19245 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
19246
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019247table_kbytes_in(<table>)
19248 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19249 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019250 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019251 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19252 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19253 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
19254 keyword.
19255
19256table_kbytes_out(<table>)
19257 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19258 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019259 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019260 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19261 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19262 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
19263 keyword.
19264
19265table_server_id(<table>)
19266 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19267 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19268 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
19269 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
19270 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
19271 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
19272
19273table_sess_cnt(<table>)
19274 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19275 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019276 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019277 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
19278 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19279 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
19280 keyword.
19281
19282table_sess_rate(<table>)
19283 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19284 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19285 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
19286 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
19287 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19288 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
19289 keyword.
19290
19291table_trackers(<table>)
19292 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19293 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19294 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
19295 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
19296 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
19297 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
19298 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
19299 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
19300 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
19301 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
19302
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020019303ub64dec
19304 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
19305 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
19306 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
19307
19308 Example:
19309 # Decoding a JWT payload:
19310 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
19311
19312ub64enc
19313 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
19314
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020019315upper
19316 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
19317 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
19318 type. The result is of type string.
19319
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020019320url_dec([<in_form>])
19321 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
19322 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
19323 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
19324 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
19325 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
19326 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020019327
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010019328url_enc([<enc_type>])
19329 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
19330 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
19331 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
19332 optional argument is here for future changes.
19333
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019334ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019335 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019336 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
19337 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
19338 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019339 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
19340 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
19341 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
19342 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019343 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019344 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
19345 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019346
19347 Example:
19348 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
19349 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
19350
19351 message Point {
19352 int32 latitude = 1;
19353 int32 longitude = 2;
19354 }
19355
19356 message PPoint {
19357 Point point = 59;
19358 }
19359
19360 message Rectangle {
19361 // One corner of the rectangle.
19362 PPoint lo = 48;
19363 // The other corner of the rectangle.
19364 PPoint hi = 49;
19365 }
19366
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019367 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
19368 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
19369 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019370
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019371 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19372 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019373 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019374 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
19375
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019376 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019377
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019378 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019379
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019380 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
19381 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19382 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019383
19384 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
19385 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
19386 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
19387
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019388 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
19389 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
19390 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019391
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019392
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010019393unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010019394 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
19395 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
19396 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
19397 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19398 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
19399 response),
19400 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19401 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
19402 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
19403 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
19404
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019405utime(<format>[,<offset>])
19406 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
19407 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
19408 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
19409 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
19410 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
19411 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
19412
19413 Example :
19414
19415 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019416 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019417 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
19418
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019419word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
19420 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
19421 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
19422 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019423 Empty words are skipped. This means that delimiters at the start or end of
19424 the input string are ignored and consecutive delimiters within the input
19425 string are considered to be a single delimiter.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019426 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
19427 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
19428
19429 Example :
19430 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019431 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(5,_) # <not found>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019432 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
19433 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
19434 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
19435 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010019436 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019437 str(/f1////f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010019438
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019439wt6([<avalanche>])
19440 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
19441 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
19442 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
19443 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
19444 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
19445 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
19446 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010019447 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
19448 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019449
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019450xor(<value>)
19451 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019452 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019453 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019454 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019455 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019456 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19457 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019458 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019459 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19460 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019461 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019462 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019463
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010019464xxh3([<seed>])
19465 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
19466 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
19467 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
19468 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
19469 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
19470 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
19471 considered as cryptographically secure.
19472
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010019473xxh32([<seed>])
19474 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
19475 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19476 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19477 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19478 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19479 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19480 as cryptographically secure.
19481
19482xxh64([<seed>])
19483 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
19484 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19485 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19486 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19487 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19488 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19489 as cryptographically secure.
19490
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019491x509_v_err_str
19492 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
19493 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
19494 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
19495
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019496 When the corresponding constant name was not found, outputs the numerical
19497 value as a string.
19498
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019499 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
19500 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
19501 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
19502
19503 Example:
19504
19505 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19506
19507 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19508 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
19509 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
19510
19511 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
19512 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
19513 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019514
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019515 http-response add-header X-SSL-verify %[ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str]
19516
19517
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200195187.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019519--------------------------------------------
19520
19521A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
19522not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
Aurelien DARRAGON4bd597b2023-11-30 11:11:43 +010019523"monitor fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019524The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
19525
19526always_false : boolean
19527 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19528 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19529
19530always_true : boolean
19531 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19532 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19533
19534avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019535 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019536 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
19537 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
19538 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
19539 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
19540 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
19541 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
19542 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
19543 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
19544 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
19545 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
19546 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
19547 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
19548 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010019549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019550be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019551 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
19552 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
19553 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
19554 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019555 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
19556
19557be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
19558 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19559 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
19560 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
19561 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
19562 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019563 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
19564 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019565
19566 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
19567 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
19568 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019570be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
19571 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19572 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19573 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019574 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019575 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
19576 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019577
19578 Example :
19579 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
19580 backend dynamic
19581 mode http
19582 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
19583 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019584
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019585bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019586 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
19587 of the string.
19588
19589bool(<bool>) : bool
19590 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
19591 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
19592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019593connslots([<backend>]) : integer
19594 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019595 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019596 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
19597 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050019598
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019599 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019600 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019601 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
19602
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019603 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
19604 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019605
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019606 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019607 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019608 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019609 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019610 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019611 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019612 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019613
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019614 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
19615 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019616 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019617 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019618
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019619cpu_calls : integer
19620 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
19621 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
19622 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
19623 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
19624 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
19625 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
19626
19627cpu_ns_avg : integer
19628 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19629 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19630 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19631 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19632 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19633 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19634 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
19635 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
19636 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
19637 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
19638 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
19639
19640cpu_ns_tot : integer
19641 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19642 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19643 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19644 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19645 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19646 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19647 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
19648 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
19649 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
19650 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
19651 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
19652 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
19653 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
19654
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010019655date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019656 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019657
19658 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
19659 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
19660 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019661 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
19662
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019663 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
19664 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
19665 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
19666 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
19667 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
19668
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019669 Example :
19670
19671 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
19672 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019673
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019674 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
19675 # millisecond granularity
19676 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
19677
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010019678date_us : integer
19679 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
19680 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
19681 from the same timeval structure.
19682
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019683env(<name>) : string
19684 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
19685 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
19686 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
19687 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
19688 certain way.
19689
19690 Examples :
19691 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
19692 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
19693
19694 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019695 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019697fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
19698 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019699 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
19700 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019701 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
19702 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019703 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019704 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
19705 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019706
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020019707fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19708 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
19709 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
19710 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
19711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019712fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19713 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19714 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19715 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
19716 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
19717 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
19718 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
19719 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
19720 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019721
19722 Example :
19723 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
19724 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
19725 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
19726 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
19727 frontend mail
19728 bind :25
19729 mode tcp
19730 maxconn 100
19731 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
19732 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
19733 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
19734 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019735
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010019736hostname : string
19737 Returns the system hostname.
19738
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019739int(<integer>) : signed integer
19740 Returns a signed integer.
19741
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019742ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
19743 Returns an ipv4.
19744
19745ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
19746 Returns an ipv6.
19747
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019748last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019749 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
19750 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
19751 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19752 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19753 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19754 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19755 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19756 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19757 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19758 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19759 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19760 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
19761
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019762last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019763 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
19764 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
19765 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19766 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19767 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19768 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19769 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19770 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19771 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19772 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19773 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19774 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
19775
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019776lat_ns_avg : integer
19777 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19778 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19779 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19780 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19781 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19782 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19783 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19784 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19785 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019786 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19787 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19788 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19789 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19790 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
19791 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019792
19793lat_ns_tot : integer
19794 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19795 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19796 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19797 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19798 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19799 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19800 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19801 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19802 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019803 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19804 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19805 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19806 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19807 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019808 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
19809 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
19810 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
19811 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
19812 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
19813 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
19814
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019815meth(<method>) : method
19816 Returns a method.
19817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019818nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
19819 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
19820 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
19821 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019822 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
19823 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
19824 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019825
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040019826prio_class : integer
19827 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
19828 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
19829 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
19830
19831prio_offset : integer
19832 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
19833 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
19834 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
19835 set-priority-offset".
19836
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019837proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020019838 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
19839 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019841queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019842 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
19843 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
19844 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019845 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
19846 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
19847 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
19848 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
19849 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
19850
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019851quic_enabled : boolean
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019852 Return true when the support for QUIC transport protocol was compiled and
19853 if this procotol was not disabled by "no-quic" global option. See also "no-quic"
19854 global option.
19855
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010019856rand([<range>]) : integer
19857 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
19858 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
19859 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
19860 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
19861 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
19862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019863srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19864 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19865 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
19866 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
19867 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
19868 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019869 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
19870 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
19871
19872srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19873 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19874 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
19875 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19876 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
19877 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
19878 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
19879 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
19880
19881 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
19882 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019883
19884srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
19885 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
19886 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
19887 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019888 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019889 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
19890 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
19891 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
19892
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020019893srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19894 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
19895 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19896 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
19897 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
19898 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
19899 fetch methods.
19900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019901srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19902 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19903 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019904 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019905 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
19906 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019907 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019908 overloading servers).
19909
19910 Example :
19911 # Redirect to a separate back
19912 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
19913 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
19914 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
19915
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019916srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019917 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
19918 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
19919 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
19920
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019921srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019922 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
19923 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19924 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
19925
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019926srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019927 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
19928 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19929 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
19930
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019931stopping : boolean
19932 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
19933 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
19934 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
19935
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019936str(<string>) : string
19937 Returns a string.
19938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019939table_avl([<table>]) : integer
19940 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
19941 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
19942
19943table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19944 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
19945 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
19946 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
19947
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010019948thread : integer
19949 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
19950 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
19951 and debugging purposes.
19952
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020019953uuid([<version>]) : string
19954 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
19955 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
19956 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
19957
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019958var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019959 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019960 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
19961 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
19962 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019963 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019964 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19965 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019966 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019967 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19968 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019969 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019970 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019971
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200199727.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019973----------------------------------
19974
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019975The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019976closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
19977methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
19978sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
19979TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019980the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
19981counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020019982"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +010019983used if the global "tune.stick-counters" value does not exceed 3, otherwise the
19984counter number can be specified as the first integer argument when using the
19985"sc_" prefix starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (tune.stick-counters-1).
19986An optional table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the
19987currently tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of
19988the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019989
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019990bc_dst : ip
19991 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
19992 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
19993 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
19994 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19995
19996bc_dst_port : integer
19997 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019998 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019999
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010020000bc_err : integer
20001 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
20002 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
20003 and their corresponding error message.
20004
20005bc_err_str : string
20006 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
20007 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
20008 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
20009 corresponding error message.
20010
Willy Tarreau0d953302024-01-17 18:00:21 +010020011bc_glitches : integer
20012 Returns the number of protocol glitches counted on the backend connection.
20013 These generally cover protocol violations as well as small anomalies that
20014 generally indicate a bogus or misbehaving server that may cause trouble in
20015 the infrastructure (e.g. cause connections to be aborted early, inducing
20016 frequent TLS renegotiations). These may also be caused by too large responses
20017 that cannot fit into a single buffer, explaining HTTP 502 errors. Ideally
20018 this number should remain zero, though it's generally fine if it remains very
20019 low compared to the total number of requests. These values should normally
20020 not be considered as alarming (especially small ones), though a sudden jump
20021 may indicate an anomaly somewhere. Not all protocol multiplexers measure this
20022 metric and the only way to get more details about the events is to enable
20023 traces to capture all exchanges.
20024
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010020025bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010020026 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
20027 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
20028 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
20029
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020020030bc_src : ip
20031 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020032 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020020033 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
20034 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
20035
20036bc_src_port : integer
20037 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020038 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020020039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020040be_id : integer
20041 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020042 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
20043 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020044
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010020045be_name : string
20046 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020047 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
20048 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010020049
Aleksandar Lazic5529c992023-04-28 11:39:12 +020020050bc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
20051 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the backend
20052 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
20053 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
20054 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20055 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20056 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20057
20058bc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
20059 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
20060 backend connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
20061 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
20062 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20063 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20064 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20065
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010020066be_server_timeout : integer
20067 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
20068 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
20069 also the "cur_server_timeout".
20070
20071be_tunnel_timeout : integer
20072 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
20073 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
20074 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
20075
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010020076cur_server_timeout : integer
20077 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
20078 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
20079 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
20080
20081cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
20082 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
20083 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
20084 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
20085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020086dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020087 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
20088 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
20089 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
20090 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
20091 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
20092 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
20093 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
20094 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
20095 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
20096 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
20097 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020098
20099dst_conn : integer
20100 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
20101 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
20102 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
20103 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
20104 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
20105 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
20106 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
20107 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020108
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020109dst_is_local : boolean
20110 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
20111 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
20112 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
20113 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020114 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020115 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
20116 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
20117 it only once per connection.
20118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020119dst_port : integer
20120 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
20121 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020122 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
20123 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
20124 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
20125 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020126
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010020127fc_dst : ip
20128 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
20129 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
20130 for details.
20131
20132fc_dst_is_local : boolean
20133 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
20134 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
20135 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
20136
20137fc_dst_port : integer
20138 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
20139 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
20140 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
20141
20142fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020143 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
20144 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
20145 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020020146 described in section 8.2.5). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020147 error codes and their corresponding error message.
20148
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010020149fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050020150 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020151 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020020152 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.5). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020153 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
20154
20155 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20156 | ID | message |
20157 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20158 | 0 | "Success" |
20159 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
20160 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
20161 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
20162 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
20163 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
20164 | 6 | "General socket error" |
20165 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
20166 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
20167 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
20168 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
20169 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
20170 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
20171 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
20172 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
20173 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
20174 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
20175 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
20176 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
20177 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
20178 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
20179 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
20180 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
20181 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
20182 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
20183 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
20184 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
20185 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
20186 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
20187 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
20188 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
20189 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
20190 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
20191 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
20192 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
20193 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
20194 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
20195 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
20196 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
20197 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
20198 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
20199 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
20200 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020020201 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020202 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20203
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020204fc_fackets : integer
20205 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
20206 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20207 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20208 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20209
Willy Tarreau0d953302024-01-17 18:00:21 +010020210fc_glitches : integer
20211 Returns the number of protocol glitches counted on the frontend connection.
20212 These generally cover protocol violations as well as small anomalies that
20213 generally indicate a bogus or misbehaving client that may cause trouble in
20214 the infrastructure, such as excess of errors in the logs, or many connections
20215 being aborted early, inducing frequent TLS renegotiations. These may also be
20216 caused by too large requests that cannot fit into a single buffer, explaining
20217 HTTP 400 errors. Ideally this number should remain zero, though it may be
20218 possible that some browsers playing with the protocol boundaries trigger it
20219 once in a while. These values should normally not be considered as alarming
20220 (especially small ones), though a sudden jump may indicate an anomaly
20221 somewhere. Large values (i.e. hundreds to thousands per connection, or as
20222 many as the requests) may indicate a purposely built client that is trying to
20223 fingerprint or attack the protocol stack. Not all protocol multiplexers
20224 measure this metric, and the only way to get more details about the events is
20225 to enable traces to capture all exchanges.
20226
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020020227fc_http_major : integer
20228 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
20229 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
20230 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
20231
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020232fc_lost : integer
20233 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
20234 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20235 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20236 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20237
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020020238fc_pp_authority : string
20239 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
20240 if any.
20241
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010020242fc_pp_unique_id : string
20243 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
20244 if any.
20245
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010020246fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
20247 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
20248 header.
20249
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020250fc_reordering : integer
20251 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
20252 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20253 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20254 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20255
20256fc_retrans : integer
20257 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
20258 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20259 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20260 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20261
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020020262fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
20263 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
20264 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
20265 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
20266 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20267 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20268 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20269
20270fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
20271 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
20272 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
20273 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
20274 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20275 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20276 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20277
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020020278fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020279 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20280 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20281 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20282 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20283
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020284fc_src : ip
Christopher Faulet18b63f42023-07-17 07:56:55 +020020285 This is the original source IP address of the connection on the client side
20286 Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src" for
20287 details.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020288
20289fc_src_is_local : boolean
20290 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
20291 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
20292 "src_is_local" for details.
20293
20294fc_src_port : integer
20295
20296 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
20297 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
20298 this address. See "src-port" for details.
20299
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020300
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020301fc_unacked : integer
20302 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20303 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20304 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20305 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020306
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020020307fe_defbe : string
20308 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
20309 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
20310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020311fe_id : integer
20312 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010020313 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020314 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20315
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010020316fe_name : string
20317 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
20318 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
20319 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20320
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010020321fe_client_timeout : integer
20322 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
20323 current frontend.
20324
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020325sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020326sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20327sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20328sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020329 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
20330 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20331 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
20332
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020333sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020334sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20335sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20336sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020337 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
20338 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20339 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
20340
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020341sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20342 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20343 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20344 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20345 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20346 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20347 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20348 will always return zero.
20349 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20350 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20351
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020352sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020353sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20354sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20355sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020356 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20357 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020358 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20359 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20360 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020361
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020362 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020363 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20364 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020365 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20366 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
20367 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020368 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20369 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20370
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020371sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20372sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20373sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20374sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20375 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20376 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
20377 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20378 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20379 when a first ACL was verified.
20380
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020381sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020382sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20383sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20384sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020385 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020386 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
20387
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020388sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020389sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20390sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20391sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020392 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20393 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
20394 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
20395
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020396sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020397sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20398sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20399sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020400 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
20401 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
20402 See also src_conn_rate.
20403
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020404sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20405 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
20406 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
20407 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
20408 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20409 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
20410 index, zero is returned.
20411 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20412 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
20413
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020414sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020415sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20416sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20417sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020418 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020419 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020420
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020421sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20422sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20423sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20424sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20425 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20426 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20427
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020428sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20429 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20430 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
20431 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20432 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20433 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
20434 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
20435 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
20436
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020437sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20438sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20439sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20440sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20441 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20442 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
20443
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020444sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20445 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20446 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
20447 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
20448 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
20449 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
20450 between 0 and 2.
20451 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
20452 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20453 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20454 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20455 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20456
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020457sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020458sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20459sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20460sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020461 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
20462 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20463 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020464 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20465 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20466 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020467
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020468sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20469sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20470sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20471sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20472 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20473 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20474 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20475 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20476 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20477 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20478
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020479sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020480sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20481sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20482sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020483 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020484 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
20485 See also src_http_err_cnt.
20486
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020487sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020488sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20489sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20490sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020491 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
20492 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20493 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
20494 src_http_err_rate.
20495
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020496sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20497sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20498sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20499sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20500 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
20501 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
20502 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
20503
20504sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20505sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20506sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20507sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20508 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
20509 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
20510 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
20511 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
20512
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020513sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020514sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20515sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20516sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020517 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020518 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20519 src_http_req_cnt.
20520
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020521sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020522sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20523sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20524sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020525 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
20526 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
20527 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20528 src_http_req_rate.
20529
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020530sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20531 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20532 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20533 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20534 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20535 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20536 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20537 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
20538 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20539 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20540
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020541sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020542sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20543sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20544sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020545 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020546 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20547 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20548 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20549 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020550
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020551 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020552 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20553 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020554 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20555
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020556sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20557sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20558sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20559sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20560 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
20561 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20562 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20563 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20564 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
20565
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020566sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020567sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20568sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20569sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020570 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
20571 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20572 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020573
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020574sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020575sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20576sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20577sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020578 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
20579 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20580 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020581
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020582sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020583sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20584sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20585sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020586 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020587 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
20588 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
20589 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020590 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020591 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
20592
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020593sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020594sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20595sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20596sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020597 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
20598 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20599 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
20600 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
20601 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020602 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020603
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020604sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020605sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20606sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20607sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020020608 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
20609 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
20610 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
20611
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020612sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020613sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20614sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20615sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020616 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20617 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020618 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020619 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
20620 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020621 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
20622 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
20623 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020625so_id : integer
20626 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
20627 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
20628 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020629
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010020630so_name : string
20631 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
20632 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
20633 strings instead of integers.
20634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020635src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020636 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
20637 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
20638 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
20639 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
20640 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
20641 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
20642 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
20643 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
20644 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
20645 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
20646 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
20647 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
20648 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
20649 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
20650 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020651
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010020652 Example:
20653 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
20654 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
20655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020656src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20657 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
20658 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
20659 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020660 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020662src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20663 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
20664 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020665 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020666 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020667
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020668src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20669 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20670 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20671 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
20672 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20673 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
20674 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20675 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20676 See also sc_clr_gpc.
20677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020678src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20679 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20680 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20681 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20682 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20683 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20684 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020685
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020686 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020687 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20688 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
20689 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
20690 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020691 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020692 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20693 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20694
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020695src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20696 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20697 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20698 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20699 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20700 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20701 was verified.
20702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020703src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020704 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020705 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020706 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020707 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020709src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020710 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020711 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20712 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020713 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020715src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20716 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
20717 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20718 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020719 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020720
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020721src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20722 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
20723 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20724 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20725 is an integer between 0 and 99.
20726 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
20727 is returned.
20728 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
20729 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20730 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
20731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020732src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020733 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020734 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020735 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020736 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020737
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020738src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20739 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20740 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20741 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20742 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
20743
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020744src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20745 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20746 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20747 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
20748 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20749 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
20750 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
20751
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020752src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20753 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20754 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20755 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20756 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
20757
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020758src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20759 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20760 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
20761 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20762 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
20763 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20764 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
20765 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20766 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20767 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20768 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020770src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020771 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020772 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020773 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20774 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020775 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20776 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20777 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020778
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020779src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20780 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20781 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20782 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20783 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20784 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20785 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20786 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020788src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020789 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020790 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020791 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020792 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020793 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020795src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20796 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
20797 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20798 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20799 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020800 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020801
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020802src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20803 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
20804 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050020805 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020806 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
20807 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20808
20809src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20810 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
20811 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20812 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
20813 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
20814 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
20815 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
20816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020817src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020818 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020819 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20820 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020821 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020823src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20824 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
20825 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20826 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020827 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020828 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020829
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020830src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20831 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
20832 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20833 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
20834 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20835 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
20836 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20837 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20838 See also sc_inc_gpc.
20839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020840src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20841 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20842 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20843 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020844 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020845 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20846 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020847
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020848 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020849 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020850 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020851 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020852
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020853src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20854 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20855 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20856 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
20857 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20858 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20859 connection when a first ACL was verified.
20860
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020861src_is_local : boolean
20862 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
20863 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
20864 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
20865 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020866 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020867 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
20868 once per connection.
20869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020870src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020871 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
20872 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20873 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
20874 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
20875 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020877src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020878 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
20879 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20880 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
20881 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
20882 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020884src_port : integer
20885 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020886 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
20887 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
20888 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
20889 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010020890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020891src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020892 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020893 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20894 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
20895 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020896 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020898src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20899 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
20900 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20901 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20902 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020903 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020905src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20906 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
20907 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
20908 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
20909 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
20910 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
20911 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
20912 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
20913 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020914
20915 Example :
20916 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
20917 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
20918 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
20919 listen ssh
20920 bind :22
20921 mode tcp
20922 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020923 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020924 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020925 server local 127.0.0.1:22
20926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020927srv_id : integer
20928 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
20929 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020930 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020020931
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020932srv_name : string
20933 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
20934 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020935 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020936
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200209377.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020938----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020020939
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020940The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020941closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
20942when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
20943usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020944future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020945
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00002094651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
20947 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
20948 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
20949 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
20950 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
20951 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
20952
20953 Example :
20954 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
20955 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
20956 # the request.
20957 frontend http-in
20958 bind *:8081
20959 default_backend servers
20960 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
20961 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
20962
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020963ssl_bc : boolean
20964 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20965 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Mariam John6ff043d2023-05-22 13:11:13 -050020966 to a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020967 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020968
20969ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
20970 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020971 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20972 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020973
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020974ssl_bc_alpn : string
20975 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
20976 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020977 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020978 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20979 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20980 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
20981 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
20982 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020983 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
20984 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020985
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020986ssl_bc_cipher : string
20987 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020988 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20989 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020990
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020991ssl_bc_client_random : binary
20992 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20993 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20994 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020995 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020996
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020997ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020998 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020999 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
21000 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
21001 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
21002 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020021003 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
21004 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
21005 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
21006
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021007ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020021008 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021009 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
21010 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
21011 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020021012
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010021013ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
21014 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21015 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020021016 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
21017 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010021018
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010021019ssl_bc_npn : string
21020 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
21021 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020021022 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010021023 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
21024 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
21025 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
21026 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020021027 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
21028 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010021029
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020021030ssl_bc_protocol : string
21031 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020021032 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
21033 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020021034
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021035ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020021036 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021037 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020021038 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
21039 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020021040
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021041ssl_bc_server_random : binary
21042 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
21043 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21044 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020021045 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021046
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020021047ssl_bc_session_id : binary
21048 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
21049 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020021050 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
21051 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020021052
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040021053ssl_bc_session_key : binary
21054 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
21055 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
21056 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020021057 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040021058
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020021059ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
21060 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020021061 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
21062 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020021063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021064ssl_c_ca_err : integer
21065 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21066 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
21067 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
21068 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
21069 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020021070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021071ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
21072 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21073 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
21074 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
21075 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021076
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010021077ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021078 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
21079 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21080 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050021081 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021082 does not support resumed sessions.
21083
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010021084ssl_c_der : binary
21085 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
21086 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21087 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021089ssl_c_err : integer
21090 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21091 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
21092 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
21093 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
21094 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021095
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021096ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021097 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21098 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21099 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21100 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21101 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21102 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21103 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21104 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021105 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21106 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21107 LDAP v3.
21108 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21109 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021111ssl_c_key_alg : string
21112 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21113 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21114 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021116ssl_c_notafter : string
21117 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
21118 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21119 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020021120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021121ssl_c_notbefore : string
21122 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
21123 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21124 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010021125
Abhijeet Rastogidf97f472023-05-13 20:04:45 -070021126ssl_c_r_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21127 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and is
21128 successfully validated with the configured ca-file, returns the full
21129 distinguished name of the root CA of the certificate presented by the client
21130 when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the first given entry found from
21131 the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative occurrence number is specified
21132 as the optional second argument, it returns the value of the nth given entry
21133 value from the beginning/end of the DN. For instance, "ssl_c_r_dn(OU,2)" the
21134 second organization unit, and "ssl_c_r_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name. The
21135 <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for consumption by
21136 different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for LDAP v3. If you'd like
21137 to modify the format only you can specify an empty string and zero for the
21138 first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_r_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21139
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021140ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021141 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21142 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21143 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21144 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21145 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21146 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21147 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21148 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021149 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21150 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21151 LDAP v3.
21152 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21153 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010021154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021155ssl_c_serial : binary
21156 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
21157 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21158 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021160ssl_c_sha1 : binary
21161 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
21162 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
21163 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020021164 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
21165 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
21166
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030021167 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020021168 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021170ssl_c_sig_alg : string
21171 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21172 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21173 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021175ssl_c_used : boolean
21176 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
21177 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021179ssl_c_verify : integer
21180 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
21181 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
21182 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
21183 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021185ssl_c_version : integer
21186 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
21187 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021188
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010021189ssl_f_der : binary
21190 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
21191 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21192 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21193
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021194ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021195 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21196 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21197 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21198 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021199 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021200 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21201 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21202 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021203 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21204 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21205 LDAP v3.
21206 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21207 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021209ssl_f_key_alg : string
21210 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21211 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
21212 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021214ssl_f_notafter : string
21215 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
21216 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21217 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021219ssl_f_notbefore : string
21220 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
21221 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21222 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021223
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021224ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021225 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21226 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21227 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21228 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21229 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21230 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21231 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21232 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021233 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21234 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21235 LDAP v3.
21236 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21237 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021239ssl_f_serial : binary
21240 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
21241 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21242 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021243
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020021244ssl_f_sha1 : binary
21245 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
21246 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21247 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021249ssl_f_sig_alg : string
21250 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21251 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21252 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021254ssl_f_version : integer
21255 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
21256 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21257
21258ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021259 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
21260 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
21261 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
21262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021263 Example :
21264 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
21265 listen http-https
21266 bind :80
21267 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
21268 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
21269
21270ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
21271 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
21272 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21273
21274ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021275 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021276 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021277 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021278 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
21279 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
21280 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
21281 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
21282 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
21283 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
21284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021285ssl_fc_cipher : string
21286 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
21287 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020021288
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021289ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21290 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
21291 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021292 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021293 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21294 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21295 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021296
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021297 Example:
21298 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21299 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21300 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21301 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21302 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21303 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21304 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21305 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21306 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21307
21308ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021309 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021310 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021311 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
21312 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021313 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21314 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021315
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021316ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021317 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021318 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021319 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021320 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21321 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21322 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21323 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
21324 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
21325 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021326
21327ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021328 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021329 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
21330 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021331
21332ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
21333 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
21334 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021335 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021336
21337 Example:
21338 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21339 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21340 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21341 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21342 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21343 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21344 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21345 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21346 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21347
21348ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21349 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
21350 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021351 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021352 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21353 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
21354 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21355
21356 Example:
21357 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21358 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21359 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21360 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21361 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21362 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21363 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21364 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21365 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21366
21367ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21368 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
21369 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021370 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021371 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21372 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
21373 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21374
21375 Example:
21376 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21377 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21378 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21379 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21380 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21381 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21382 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21383 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21384 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021385
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021386ssl_fc_client_random : binary
21387 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21388 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21389 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21390
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021391ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
21392 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21393 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21394 transport layer.
21395 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21396 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21397 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21398 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21399
21400ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21401 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21402 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21403 transport layer.
21404 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21405 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21406 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21407 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21408
21409ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
21410 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21411 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21412 transport layer.
21413 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21414 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21415 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21416 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21417
21418ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
21419 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21420 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21421 transport layer.
21422 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21423 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21424 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21425 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21426
21427ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
21428 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21429 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21430 transport layer.
21431 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21432 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21433 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21434 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21435
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021436ssl_fc_err : integer
21437 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21438 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
21439 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
21440 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
21441 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
21442 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
21443 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
21444 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
21445 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
21446 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
21447 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
21448 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
21449 codes.
21450
21451ssl_fc_err_str : string
21452 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21453 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
21454 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
21455 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
21456 also "ssl_fc_err".
21457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021458ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021459 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
21460 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010021461 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
21462 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
21463 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
21464 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021465
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020021466ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
21467 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
21468 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
21469 wait until the handshake happened.
21470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021471ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
21472 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021473 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
21474 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021475 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021476 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021477
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020021478ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021479 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010021480 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
21481 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021483ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021484 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021485 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021486 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
21487 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
21488 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
21489 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
21490 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
21491 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020021492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021493ssl_fc_protocol : string
21494 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
21495 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021496
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021497ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
21498 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
21499 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021500 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
21501 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021502
21503 Example:
21504 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21505 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21506 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21507 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21508 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21509 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21510 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21511 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21512 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21513
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021514ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021515 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021516 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010021517 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021518
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021519ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21520 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21521 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21522 transport layer.
21523 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21524 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21525 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21526 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21527
21528ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
21529 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21530 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21531 transport layer.
21532 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21533 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21534 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21535 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21536
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021537ssl_fc_server_random : binary
21538 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21539 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21540 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021542ssl_fc_session_id : binary
21543 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
21544 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
21545 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
21546 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021547
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040021548ssl_fc_session_key : binary
21549 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
21550 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
21551 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
21552 BoringSSL.
21553
21554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021555ssl_fc_sni : string
21556 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
21557 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021558 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021559 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
21560 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
21561
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021562 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021563 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021564 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021565 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020021566 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021567
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010021568 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
21569 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
21570 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
21571 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
21572 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
21573 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
21574 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
21575 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
21576 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
21577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021578 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021579 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
21580 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020021581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021582ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
21583 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
21584 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021585
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021586ssl_s_der : binary
21587 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
21588 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21589 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21590
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021591ssl_s_chain_der : binary
21592 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
21593 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21594 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050021595 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021596 does not support resumed sessions.
21597
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021598ssl_s_key_alg : string
21599 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21600 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
21601 SSL/TLS transport layer.
21602
21603ssl_s_notafter : string
21604 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
21605 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21606 transport layer.
21607
21608ssl_s_notbefore : string
21609 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
21610 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21611 transport layer.
21612
21613ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21614 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21615 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21616 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21617 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21618 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21619 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021620 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21621 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021622 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21623 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21624 LDAP v3.
21625 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21626 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21627
21628ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21629 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21630 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21631 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21632 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21633 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21634 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021635 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21636 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021637 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21638 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21639 LDAP v3.
21640 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21641 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21642
21643ssl_s_serial : binary
21644 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
21645 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21646 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21647
21648ssl_s_sha1 : binary
21649 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
21650 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21651 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21652
21653ssl_s_sig_alg : string
21654 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21655 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21656 layer.
21657
21658ssl_s_version : integer
21659 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
21660 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021661
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200216627.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021663------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021665Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
21666sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
21667only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
21668For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
21669be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
21670can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
21671sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
21672for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
21673content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021674
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021675Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
21676 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021677 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021678 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
21679 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
21680 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
21681 sample expression). So be careful.
21682
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010021683distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
21684 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
21685 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
21686 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
21687 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
21688 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
21689 list of supported tokens.
21690
21691distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
21692 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
21693 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
21694 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
21695 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
21696 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
21697 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
21698 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
21699 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
21700 supported tokens.
21701
21702 Example :
21703 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
21704 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
21705 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
21706 # send large files to the big farm
21707 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
21708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021709payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021710 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021711 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
21712 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021714payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
21715 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021716 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021717 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021719req.len : integer
21720req_len : integer (deprecated)
21721 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21722 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21723 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21724 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21725 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021726 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021727 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
21728 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021730req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21731 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021732 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
21733 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
21734 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
21735 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021736
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021737 ACL derivatives :
21738 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021740req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21741 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21742 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21743 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
21744 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021745
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021746 ACL derivatives :
21747 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021749 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021751req.proto_http : boolean
21752req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
21753 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
21754 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
21755 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
21756 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
21757 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
21758 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
21759 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021761 Example:
21762 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
21763 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21764 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020021765 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021767req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
21768rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21769 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
21770 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
21771 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
21772 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
21773 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
21774 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
21775 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021777 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
21778 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
21779 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
21780 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
21781 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
21782 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021784 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021785 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021787 Example :
21788 listen tse-farm
21789 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
21790 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
21791 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
21792 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
21793 # apply RDP cookie persistence
21794 persist rdp-cookie
21795 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
21796 # This is only useful makes sense if
21797 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
21798 stick-table type string size 204800
21799 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
21800 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
21801 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021803 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021804 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021806req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
21807rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
21808 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
21809 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
21810 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
21811 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021813 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021814 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021815
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021816req.ssl_alpn : string
21817 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
21818 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
21819 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
21820 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
21821 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
21822 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021823 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021824
21825 Examples :
21826 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21827 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021828 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021829 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021830 default_backend bk_default
21831
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021832req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
21833 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
21834 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020021835 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
21836 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
21837 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
21838 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
21839 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021841req.ssl_hello_type : integer
21842req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21843 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21844 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
21845 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21846 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21847 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
21848 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21849 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021851req.ssl_sni : string
21852req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
21853 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
21854 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
21855 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
21856 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21857 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020021858 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
21859 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
21860 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
21861 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
21862 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
21863 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
21864 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
21865 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
21866 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021868 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021869 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021871 Examples :
21872 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21873 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021874 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021875 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021876 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021877
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053021878req.ssl_st_ext : integer
21879 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
21880 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
21881 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
21882 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
21883 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
21884 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
21885 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
21886 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
21887 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
21888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021889req.ssl_ver : integer
21890req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
21891 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
21892 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
21893 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
21894 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
21895 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21896 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
21897 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021898 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021899 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021901 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021902 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021903
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021904res.len : integer
21905 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21906 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21907 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21908 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21909 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021910 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021911 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021912 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021914res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21915 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021916 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021917 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021918 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021919 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021921res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21922 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21923 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21924 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021925 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
21926 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021928 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021929
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020021930res.ssl_hello_type : integer
21931rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21932 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21933 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
21934 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21935 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21936 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
21937 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21938 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
21939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021940wait_end : boolean
21941 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
21942 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021943 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021944 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
21945 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021946 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021947 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
21948 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021950 Examples :
21951 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
21952 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
21953 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021955 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
21956 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21957 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
21958 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
21959 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
21960 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
21961 tcp-request content reject
21962
21963
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200219647.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021965--------------------------------------
21966
21967It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
21968This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
21969data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
21970its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
21971HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
21972content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
21973to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
21974more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
21975response are indexed.
21976
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010021977Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
21978 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
21979 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
21980 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
21981 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
21982 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
21983 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
21984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021985base : string
21986 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21987 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
21988 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
21989 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
21990 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
21991 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
21992 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
21993 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
21994
21995 ACL derivatives :
21996 base : exact string match
21997 base_beg : prefix match
21998 base_dir : subdir match
21999 base_dom : domain match
22000 base_end : suffix match
22001 base_len : length match
22002 base_reg : regex match
22003 base_sub : substring match
22004
22005base32 : integer
22006 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
22007 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
22008 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020022009 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
22010 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
22011 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022012
22013base32+src : binary
22014 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
22015 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
22016 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
22017 per-URL counters.
22018
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010022019baseq : string
22020 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
22021 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
22022 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
22023 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
22024
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010022025capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
22026 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
22027 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
22028 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
22029
22030capture.req.method : string
22031 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
22032 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
22033 because it's allocated.
22034
22035capture.req.uri : string
22036 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
22037 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
22038 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
22039 allocated.
22040
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020022041capture.req.ver : string
22042 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
22043 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
22044 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
22045
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010022046capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
22047 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
22048 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
22049 The first entry is an index of 0.
22050 See also: "capture response header"
22051
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020022052capture.res.ver : string
22053 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
22054 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
22055 persistent flag.
22056
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022057req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020022058 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
22059 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
22060 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022061
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022062req.body_param([<name>[,i]]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020022063 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
22064 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
22065 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
22066 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022067 case-sensitive, unless "i" is added as a second argument. If no name is
22068 given, any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The
22069 result is a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as
22070 presented in the request body (no URL decoding is performed). Note that the
22071 ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will
22072 iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given.
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020022073
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022074req.body_len : integer
22075 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
22076 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020022077 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
22078 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022079
22080req.body_size : integer
22081 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020022082 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
22083 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022085req.cook([<name>]) : string
22086cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22087 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
22088 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
22089 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
22090 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
22091 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
22092 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
22093 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
22094 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
22095
22096 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022097 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
22098 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
22099 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
22100 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
22101 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
22102 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
22103 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
22104 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022106req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22107cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22108 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
22109 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022111req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
22112cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22113 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
22114 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
22115 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
22116 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022118cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22119 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
22120 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
22121 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
22122 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020022123 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022124 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
22125 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
22126 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
22127 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022129hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
22130 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
22131 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
22132 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
22133 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022134 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022136req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022137 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
22138 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
22139 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
22140 with headers such as User-Agent.
22141
22142 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
22143 found.
22144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022145 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
22146 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
22147 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022148 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022150req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22151 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
22152 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022153 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
22154 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022156req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022157 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
22158 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
22159 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
22160 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
22161 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
22162 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
22163 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
22164
22165 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
22166 found.
22167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022168 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
22169 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
22170 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022171 with -1 being the last one.
22172
22173 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
22174 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022176 ACL derivatives :
22177 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
22178 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
22179 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
22180 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
22181 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
22182 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
22183 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
22184 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
22185
22186req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22187hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
22188 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
22189 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022190 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
22191 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
22192 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
22193
22194 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
22195 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
22196 which contain more than one of certain headers.
22197
22198 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022199
22200req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
22201hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
22202 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
22203 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
22204 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010022205 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
22206 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
22207 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
22208 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
22209 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022210
22211 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
22212
22213 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022214
22215req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
22216hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
22217 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
22218 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
22219 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022220
22221 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
22222
22223 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022224
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010022225req.hdrs : string
22226 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
22227 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
22228 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
22229 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
22230
22231req.hdrs_bin : binary
22232 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
22233 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
22234 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
22235 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
22236 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
22237 names and values (length of 0 for both).
22238
22239 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010022240
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010022241 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
22242 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010022243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022244http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
22245 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
22246 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
22247 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22248 basic auth is supported.
22249
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020022250http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
22251 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
22252 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
22253 performed on the data sent by the client.
22254 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
22255 Authorization one.
22256
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022257http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
22258 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
22259 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
22260 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
22261 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022262 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22263 basic auth is supported.
22264
22265 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022266 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
22267 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
22268 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
22269 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022270
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022271http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022272 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
22273 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22274 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022275
22276http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022277 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
22278 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22279 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022280
22281http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022282 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
22283 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
22284 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022286http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022287 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
22288 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022289 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
22290 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022292method : integer + string
22293 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
22294 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
22295 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
22296 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
22297 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
22298 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
22299 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022301 ACL derivatives :
22302 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022304 Example :
22305 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
22306 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
22307 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022309path : string
22310 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
22311 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
22312 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
22313 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
22314 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022315 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022316 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods. Please
22317 note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#' after the path) is strictly
22318 forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be rejected. However, if the frontend
22319 receiving the request has "option accept-invalid-http-request", then this
22320 fragment part will be accepted and will also appear in the path.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022322 ACL derivatives :
22323 path : exact string match
22324 path_beg : prefix match
22325 path_dir : subdir match
22326 path_dom : domain match
22327 path_end : suffix match
22328 path_len : length match
22329 path_reg : regex match
22330 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022331
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022332pathq : string
22333 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
22334 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
22335 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
22336 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
22337 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022338 result in both cases. Please note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#'
22339 after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22340 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22341 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22342 will also appear in the path.
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022343
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022344query : string
22345 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
22346 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
22347 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
22348 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022349 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022350 which stops before the question mark.
22351
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022352req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22353 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22354 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22355 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
22356 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022358req.ver : string
22359req_ver : string (deprecated)
22360 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
William Lallemandbcb3d602023-09-04 16:49:59 +020022361 be useful for ACL. For logs use the "%HV" log variable. Some predefined ACL
22362 already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
22363
22364 Common values are "1.0", "1.1", "2.0" or "3.0".
22365
22366 In the case of http/2 and http/3, the value is not extracted from the HTTP
22367 version in the request line but is determined by the negociated protocol
22368 version.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022370 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022371 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022372
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022373res.body : binary
22374 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
22375 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022376 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22377
22378 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022379
22380res.body_len : integer
22381 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
22382 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022383 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22384
22385 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022386
22387res.body_size : integer
22388 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
22389 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
22390 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
22391 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022392 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22393
22394 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022395
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010022396res.cache_hit : boolean
22397 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
22398 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
22399
22400res.cache_name : string
22401 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
22402 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
22403 empty string.
22404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022405res.comp : boolean
22406 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
22407 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
22408 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022410res.comp_algo : string
22411 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
22412 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
22413 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022415res.cook([<name>]) : string
22416scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22417 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22418 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022419 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22420
22421 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022423 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022424 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022426res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22427scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22428 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
22429 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022430 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
22431
22432 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022434res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
22435scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22436 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22437 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022438 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22439
22440 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022442res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022443 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22444 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22445
22446 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
22447 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
22448
22449 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
22450
22451 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022453res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022454 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22455 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22456
22457 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
22458 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
22459
22460 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022462res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
22463shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022464 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22465 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22466
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022467 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022468 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
22469
22470 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022472 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022473 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
22474 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
22475 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
22476 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
22477 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
22478 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
22479 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
22480 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022481
22482res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22483shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022484 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22485 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22486
22487 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022488 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022489
22490 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022492res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
22493shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022494 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
22495 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22496
22497 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22498
22499 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022500
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022501res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22502 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22503 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22504 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022505 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22506
22507 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022509res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
22510shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022511 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
22512 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22513
22514 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22515
22516 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022517
22518res.hdrs : string
22519 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
22520 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
22521 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022522 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
22523
22524 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022525
22526res.hdrs_bin : binary
22527 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
22528 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
22529 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
22530 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
22531 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
22532 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
22533 (length of 0 for both).
22534
22535 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
22536
22537 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
22538 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022540res.ver : string
22541resp_ver : string (deprecated)
22542 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022543 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
22544
22545 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022547 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022548 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022550set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22551 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22552 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020022553 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022554 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022556 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
22557 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022559status : integer
22560 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
22561 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022562 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
22563
22564 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022565
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020022566unique-id : string
22567 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
22568 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
22569 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
22570 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
22571 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
22572 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
22573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022574url : string
22575 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
22576 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
22577 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
22578 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
22579 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
22580 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022581 also "path" and "base". Please note that any fragment reference in the URI
22582 ('#' after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22583 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22584 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22585 will also appear in the url.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022587 ACL derivatives :
22588 url : exact string match
22589 url_beg : prefix match
22590 url_dir : subdir match
22591 url_dom : domain match
22592 url_end : suffix match
22593 url_len : length match
22594 url_reg : regex match
22595 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022597url_ip : ip
22598 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
22599 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
22600 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
22601 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022602 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
22603 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022605url_port : integer
22606 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022607 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022608
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022609urlp([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
22610url_param([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022611 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
22612 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022613 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive, unless"i" is added as a
22614 third argument. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
22615 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
22616 parameter <name> as presented in the request (no URL decoding is performed).
22617 This can be used for session stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an
22618 application cookie passed as a URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks.
22619 Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and
22620 will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022622 ACL derivatives :
22623 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
22624 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
22625 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
22626 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
22627 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
22628 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
22629 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
22630 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022631
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022633 Example :
22634 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
22635 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
22636 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
22637 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022638
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022639urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022640 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
22641 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
22642 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020022643
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020022644url32 : integer
22645 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
22646 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
22647 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
22648 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
22649 is an unsigned integer.
22650
22651url32+src : binary
22652 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
22653 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
22654 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
22655
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020022656
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200226577.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022658---------------------------------------
22659
22660This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
22661used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
22662purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
22663There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
22664or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
22665any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
22666for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
22667
22668internal.htx.data : integer
22669 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
22670 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22671
22672internal.htx.free : integer
22673 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
22674 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22675
22676internal.htx.free_data : integer
22677 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
22678 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22679
22680internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010022681 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
22682 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
22683 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022684
22685internal.htx.nbblks : integer
22686 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
22687 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22688
22689internal.htx.size : integer
22690 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
22691 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22692
22693internal.htx.used : integer
22694 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
22695 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22696 direction.
22697
22698internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
22699 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22700 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
22701 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
22702 of the special value :
22703 * head : The oldest inserted block
22704 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022705 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022706
22707internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
22708 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22709 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
22710 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
22711 integer or one of the special value :
22712 * head : The oldest inserted block
22713 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022714 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022715
22716internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
22717 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22718 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
22719 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22720 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22721
22722 * head : The oldest inserted block
22723 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022724 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022725
22726internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
22727 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22728 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22729 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22730 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22731
22732 * head : The oldest inserted block
22733 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022734 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022735
22736internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
22737 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22738 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22739 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22740 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22741
22742 * head : The oldest inserted block
22743 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022744 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022745
22746internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
22747 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
22748 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
22749 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22750 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22751
22752 * head : The oldest inserted block
22753 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022754 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022755
22756internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
22757 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
22758 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
22759 it returns false.
22760
22761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200227627.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022763---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022765Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
22766every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020022767order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022769ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022770---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
22771FALSE always_false never match
22772HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
22773HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
22774HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010022775HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022776HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
22777HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
22778HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
22779HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020022780LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022781METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
22782METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
22783METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
22784METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
22785METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
22786METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
22787METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
22788METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
22789RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
22790REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
22791TRUE always_true always match
22792WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
22793---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022794
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010022795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227968. Logging
22797----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022798
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022799One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
22800provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
22801very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
22802provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
22803state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022804to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022805headers.
22806
22807In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
22808about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
22809send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
22810
22811 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
22812 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
22813 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
22814 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
22815 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022816 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060022817 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022818
22819The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
22820allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
22821as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
22822while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
22823real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
22824delay.
22825
22826
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228278.1. Log levels
22828---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022829
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022830TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022831source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022832HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
22833in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
22834track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
22835syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
22836about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022837
22838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228398.2. Log formats
22840----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022841
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022842HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022843and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
22844slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
22845options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022846
22847 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
22848 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
22849 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
22850 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
22851 extents.
22852
22853 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
22854 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
22855 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
22856 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
22857 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
22858
22859 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
22860 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
22861 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
22862 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
22863 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
22864
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020022865 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
22866 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
22867 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
22868 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
22869
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022870 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
22871
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022872Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
22873specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
22874field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
22875servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
22876always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
22877identifier.
22878
22879Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
22880 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
22881 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
22882 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
22883 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
22884
22885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228868.2.1. Default log format
22887-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022888
22889This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
22890as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
22891format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
22892
22893 Example :
22894 listen www
22895 mode http
22896 log global
22897 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22898
22899 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
22900 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
22901 (www/HTTP)
22902
22903 Field Format Extract from the example above
22904 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
22905 2 'Connect from' Connect from
22906 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
22907 4 'to' to
22908 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
22909 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
22910
22911Detailed fields description :
22912 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
22913 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
22914 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
22915 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
22916 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22917 and processed the connection.
22918 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
22919
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022920In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
22921"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
22922connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
22923
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022924It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
22925will eventually disappear.
22926
22927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200229288.2.2. TCP log format
22929---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022930
22931The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
22932is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
22933information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
22934counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
22935emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
22936environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
22937the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
22938sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022939specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022940not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22941
22942The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22943exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022944if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
22945Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022946
22947 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
22948 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
22949 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022950 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
22951 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022952
22953A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
22954are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022955
22956 Example :
22957 frontend fnt
22958 mode tcp
22959 option tcplog
22960 log global
22961 default_backend bck
22962
22963 backend bck
22964 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22965
22966 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
22967 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
22968 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
22969
22970 Field Format Extract from the example above
22971 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
22972 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
22973 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
22974 4 frontend_name fnt
22975 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
22976 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
22977 7 bytes_read* 212
22978 8 termination_state --
22979 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
22980 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22981
22982Detailed fields description :
22983 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022984 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022985 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22986 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022987 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022988 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022989 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022990
22991 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022992 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22993 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22994 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022995
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022996 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022997 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
22998 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022999 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
23000 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
23001 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
23002 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023003
23004 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
23005 and processed the connection.
23006
23007 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
23008 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
23009 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
23010 applications.
23011
23012 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
23013 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
23014 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
23015 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
23016 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
23017
23018 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
23019 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
23020 See "Timers" below for more details.
23021
23022 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
23023 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
23024 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
23025 "Timers" below for more details.
23026
23027 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023028 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023029 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
23030 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
23031 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
23032 details.
23033
23034 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
23035 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
23036 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
23037 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
23038 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
23039
23040 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
23041 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
23042 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
23043 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
23044 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
23045 for more details.
23046
23047 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023048 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023049 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
23050 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
23051 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023052 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023053
23054 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
23055 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
23056 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
23057 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
23058 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
23059 caused by a denial of service attack.
23060
23061 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
23062 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
23063 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
23064 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
23065 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
23066 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
23067 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
23068 denial of service attack.
23069
23070 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
23071 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
23072 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
23073 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
23074 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
23075 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
23076 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
23077 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
23078 be processed than on other servers.
23079
23080 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
23081 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
23082 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
23083 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023084 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023085 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
23086 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
23087 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
23088 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
23089 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
23090 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
23091 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
23092 should not be attributed to the logged server.
23093
23094 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23095 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
23096 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
23097 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
23098 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
23099 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023100 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023101 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
23102
23103 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23104 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
23105 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
23106 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
23107 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
23108 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023109 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023110 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
23111 occurs.
23112
23113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231148.2.3. HTTP log format
23115----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023116
23117The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
23118is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
23119the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
23120are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
23121emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
23122generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
23123"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
23124which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023125frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
23126is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023127
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023128The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
23129exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023130if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
23131instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023132
23133 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
23134 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
23135 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
Willy Tarreau83929532024-09-06 07:39:59 +020023136 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
23137 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023138
23139And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
23140this exact string:
23141
23142 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
23143 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
23144 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
23145 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
23146
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023147Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
23148slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
23149with a star ('*') after the field name below.
23150
23151 Example :
23152 frontend http-in
23153 mode http
23154 option httplog
23155 log global
23156 default_backend bck
23157
23158 backend static
23159 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
23160
23161 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
23162 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
23163 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023164 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023165
23166 Field Format Extract from the example above
23167 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
23168 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023169 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023170 4 frontend_name http-in
23171 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023172 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023173 7 status_code 200
23174 8 bytes_read* 2750
23175 9 captured_request_cookie -
23176 10 captured_response_cookie -
23177 11 termination_state ----
23178 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
23179 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
23180 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
23181 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
23182 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023183
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023184Detailed fields description :
23185 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023186 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010023187 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
23188 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010023189 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023190 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010023191 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023192
23193 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010023194 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
23195 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
23196 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023197
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023198 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023199 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023200
23201 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
23202 and processed the connection.
23203
23204 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
23205 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
23206 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
23207
23208 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
23209 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
23210 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
23211 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
23212 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
23213 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
23214
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023215 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
23216 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
23217 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023218 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023219 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
23220 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023221 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023222 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023223
23224 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
23225 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023226 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023227
23228 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
23229 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023230 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
23231 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023232
23233 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
23234 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
23235 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
23236 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
23237 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023238 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
23239 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023240
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023241 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023242 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
23243 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
23244 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
23245 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
23246 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
23247 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023248 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023249
23250 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023251 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
23252 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023253
23254 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
23255 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023256 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023257 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
23258 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
23259 overflowing.
23260
23261 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
23262 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
23263 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
23264 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
23265 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
23266 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
23267 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
23268 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23269
23270 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
23271 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
23272 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
23273 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
23274 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
23275 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
23276 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
23277 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23278
23279 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
23280 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
23281 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
23282 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
23283 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
23284 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
23285 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
23286
23287 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023288 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023289 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
23290 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
23291 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023292 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023293 system.
23294
23295 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
23296 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
23297 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
23298 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
23299 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
23300 caused by a denial of service attack.
23301
23302 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
23303 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
23304 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
23305 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
23306 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
23307 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
23308 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
23309 denial of service attack.
23310
23311 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
23312 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
23313 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
23314 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
23315 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
23316 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
23317 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
23318 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
23319 processed than on other servers.
23320
23321 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
23322 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
23323 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
23324 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023325 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023326 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
23327 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
23328 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
23329 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
23330 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
23331 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
23332 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
23333 should not be attributed to the logged server.
23334
23335 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23336 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
23337 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
23338 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
23339 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
23340 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023341 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023342 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
23343
23344 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23345 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
23346 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
23347 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
23348 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
23349 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023350 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023351 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
23352 occurs.
23353
23354 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
23355 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
23356 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
23357 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
23358 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
23359 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
23360 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
23361 cookies" below for more details.
23362
23363 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
23364 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
23365 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
23366 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
23367 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
23368 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
23369 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
23370 and cookies" below for more details.
23371
23372 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
23373 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
23374 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
23375 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
23376 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
23377 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
23378 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
23379 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
23380
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023381
233828.2.4. HTTPS log format
23383----------------------
23384
23385The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
23386extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
23387information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
23388frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
23389end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
23390matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
23391sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
23392dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
23393"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
23394
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023395The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
23396exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023397if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
23398instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023399
23400 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
23401 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
23402 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
23403 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023404 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023405 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
23406 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023407
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023408This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
23409appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
23410HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023411
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023412 Example :
23413 frontend https-in
23414 mode http
23415 option httpslog
23416 log global
23417 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
23418 default_backend bck
23419
23420 backend static
23421 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
23422
23423 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
23424 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
23425 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023426 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
23427 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023428
23429 Field Format Extract from the example above
23430 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
23431 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
23432 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
23433 4 frontend_name https-in
23434 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
23435 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
23436 7 status_code 200
23437 8 bytes_read* 2750
23438 9 captured_request_cookie -
23439 10 captured_response_cookie -
23440 11 termination_state ----
23441 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
23442 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
23443 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
23444 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
23445 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023446 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023447 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023448 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
23449 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023450
23451Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023452 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
23453 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
23454 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023455
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023456 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
23457 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
23458 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050023459 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023460 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023461
23462 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
23463 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
23464 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
23465 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
23466
23467 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
23468 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
23469 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
23470 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
23471
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023472 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
23473 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
23474 can be shared by multiple requests.
23475
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023476 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
23477 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
23478 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
23479 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
23480 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
23481
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023482 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
23483
23484 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
23485
23486
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100234878.2.5. Error log format
23488-----------------------
23489
23490When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
23491protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
23492unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
23493line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
23494"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
23495will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
23496logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
23497
23498The default format looks like this :
23499
23500 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
23501 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
23502 Connection error during SSL handshake
23503
23504 Field Format Extract from the example above
23505 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
23506 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
23507 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
23508 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
23509 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
23510
23511These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
23512failures.
23513
23514By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
23515above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
23516defined format.
23517
23518An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
23519source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
23520number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
23521internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
23522error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
23523the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
23524certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
23525indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
23526indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
23527ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
23528are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
23529would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
23530regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
23531
23532 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010023533 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010023534 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
23535 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
23536
23537
235388.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023539------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023540
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023541When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
23542ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
23543a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
23544formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
23545looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
23546and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023547
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023548HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023549Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
23550separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
23551prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
23552
23553Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
23554variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023555("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023556
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023557If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020023558as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023559less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
23560the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
23561
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020023562Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
23563"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
23564delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
23565preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023566
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023567Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
23568'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
23569https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
23570such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
23571
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023572Flags are :
23573 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023574 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023575 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
23576 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023577
23578 Example:
23579
23580 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
23581 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
23582
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023583 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
23584
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023585Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
23586
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023587 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023588 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023589 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
23590 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
23591 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023592 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
23593 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
23594 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023595 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023596 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000023597 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000023598 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000023599 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023600 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
23601 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010023602 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020023603 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023604 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010023605 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023606 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020023607 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080023608 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023609 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
23610 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
23611 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
23612 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
23613 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023614 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023615 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023616 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023617 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023618 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023619 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
23620 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023621 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23622 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
23623 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023624 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023625 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
23626 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023627 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023628 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23629 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
23630 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020023631 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020023632 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023633 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
23634 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
23635 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
23636 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020023637 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023638 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023639 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023640 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010023641 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023642 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023643 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
23644 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
23645 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023646 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023647 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
23648 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023649 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023650 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
23651 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020023652 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023653 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023654 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023655 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023656
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023657 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023658
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010023659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236608.3. Advanced logging options
23661-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023662
23663Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
23664just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
23665options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
23666for more information about their usage.
23667
23668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236698.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
23670------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023671
23672It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023673HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023674commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
23675monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
23676ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
23677
23678 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
23679 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
23680 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
23681 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
23682
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020023683 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
23684 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023685
23686 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
23687 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
23688 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
23689
23690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236918.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
23692----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023693
23694The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
23695what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
23696or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023697"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023698just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
23699log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
23700after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
23701is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
23702with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
23703with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
23704
23705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200237068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
23707------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023708
23709Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
23710for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
23711"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
23712retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
23713raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
23714a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
23715file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
23716you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
23717"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
23718
23719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200237208.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
23721--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023722
23723Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
23724multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
23725them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
23726"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
23727logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
23728error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
23729and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
23730too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
23731useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
23732alternative.
23733
23734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200237358.4. Timing events
23736------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023737
23738Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
23739reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
23740the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
23741frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023742mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
23743addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
23744
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023745Timings events in HTTP mode:
23746
23747 first request 2nd request
23748 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
23749 t tr t tr ...
23750 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
23751 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
23752 :<---- Tq ---->: :
23753 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023754 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023755 :<--------- Ta --------->:
23756
23757Timings events in TCP mode:
23758
23759 TCP session
23760 |<----------------->|
23761 t t
23762 ---|----|----|----|----|---
23763 | Th Tw Tc Td |
23764 |<------ Tt ------->|
23765
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023766 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023767 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023768 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
23769 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
23770 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023771 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023772 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
23773 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
23774 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
23775 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023776
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023777 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
23778 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
23779 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023780 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
23781 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
23782 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
23783 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
23784 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
23785 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023786
23787 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
23788 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
23789 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
23790 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
23791 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
23792 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
23793 request typed by hand during a test.
23794
23795 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
23796 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023797 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023798 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
23799 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
23800 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
23801 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023802
23803 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
23804 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
23805 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
23806 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
23807 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
23808
23809 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
23810 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
23811 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
23812 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
23813 connection never established.
23814
23815 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
23816 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
23817 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
23818 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
23819 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
23820 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
23821 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
23822 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
23823 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
23824 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
23825 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
23826
William Lallemand14894192023-07-25 09:06:51 +020023827 - Td: this is the total transfer time of the response payload till the last
23828 byte sent to the client. In HTTP it starts after the last response header
23829 (after Tr).
23830
23831 The data sent are not guaranteed to be received by the client, they can be
23832 stuck in either the kernel or the network.
23833
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023834 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
23835 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
23836 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
23837 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
23838 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
23839 by subtracting other timers when valid :
23840
23841 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
23842
23843 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
23844 "Ta" can never be negative.
23845
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023846 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
23847 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023848 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
23849 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023850 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023851
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023852 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023853
23854 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023855 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
23856 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023857
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023858 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
23859 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
23860 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
23861 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
23862 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
23863 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
23864 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
23865 prefixed with a '+' sign.
23866
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023867These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
23868protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
23869that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023870due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
23871"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
23872that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023873
23874Most common cases :
23875
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023876 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
23877 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
23878 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
23879 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
23880 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023881 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023882 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
23883 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
23884 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
23885 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
23886 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020023887 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023888
23889 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
23890 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
23891 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
23892 of ms on remote networks.
23893
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023894 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
23895 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
23896 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023897
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023898 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
23899 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023900 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023901 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
23902 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
23903 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
23904 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
23905 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
23906 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023907
23908Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
23909
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023910 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023911 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023912 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023913
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023914 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023915 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
23916 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
23917
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023918 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023919 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
23920 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
23921 flags.
23922
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023923 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
23924 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023925 Check the session termination flags, then check the
23926 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
23927 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
23928 the client connection was maintained open.
23929
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023930 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023931 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023932 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023933 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
23934
23935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200239368.5. Session state at disconnection
23937-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023938
23939TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
23940"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
239412-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
23942each of which has a special meaning :
23943
23944 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
23945 session to terminate :
23946
23947 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
23948
23949 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
23950 server explicitly refused it.
23951
23952 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
23953 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
23954 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
23955 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023956 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023957
Christopher Faulet9183dfd2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010023958 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023959
23960 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
23961 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
23962 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
23963 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
23964 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
23965
23966 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
23967 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
23968 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
23969 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
23970 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
23971
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023972 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090023973 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
23974
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023975 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070023976 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
23977 backup connections when going up.
23978
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023979 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020023980
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023981 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
23982 send or receive data.
23983
23984 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
23985 send or receive data.
23986
23987 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
23988 with nothing left in the buffers.
23989
23990 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
23991
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010023992 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023993 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
23994
23995 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
23996 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
23997 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
23998 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
23999 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
24000
24001 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
24002 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
24003
24004 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
24005 server (HTTP only).
24006
24007 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
24008
24009 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
24010 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
24011 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
24012
24013 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
24014 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
24015 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
24016
24017 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
24018
24019 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
24020 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
24021
24022 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
24023 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
24024 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
24025
24026 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
24027 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020024028 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
24029 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024030
24031 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
24032 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
24033 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
24034 another server.
24035
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024036 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024037 server.
24038
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024039 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
24040 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
24041 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
24042 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
24043
24044 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
24045 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
24046 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
24047 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
24048
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020024049 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
24050 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
24051 "use-server" rule).
24052
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024053 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
24054
24055 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
24056 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
24057
24058 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
24059
24060 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
24061 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
24062 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
24063
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024064 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
24065 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030024066 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024067 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
24068 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
24069
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024070 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
24071
24072 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
24073 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
24074
24075 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
24076
24077 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
24078
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024079The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
24080was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024081helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
24082starvation, attacks, etc...
24083
24084The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
24085alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
24086easier finding and understanding.
24087
24088 Flags Reason
24089
24090 -- Normal termination.
24091
24092 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024093 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
24094 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024095 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
24096
24097 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
24098 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024099 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
24100 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024101 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
24102 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024103
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024104 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
24105 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020024106 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024107
24108 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
24109 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
24110 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
24111
24112 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
24113 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
24114 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
24115 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
24116 the server takes too long to respond.
24117
24118 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
24119 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
24120 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
24121 long a time to respond.
24122
24123 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
24124 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
24125 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024126 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020024127 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
24128 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024129
24130 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
24131 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
24132 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
24133 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
24134 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020024135 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020024136 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
24137 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
24138 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
24139 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
24140 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
24141 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
24142 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
24143 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024144 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020024145 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
24146 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
24147 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024148
24149 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
24150 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020024151 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
24152 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
24153 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
24154 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024155
Christopher Faulet9183dfd2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010024156 LC The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
24157 request was not sent to the server. It only happens with a redirect
24158 because of a "redir" parameter on the server line.
24159
24160 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
24161 request was not sent to the server. Generally it means a redirect was
24162 returned, an HTTP return statement was processed or the request was
24163 handled by an applet (stats, cache, Prometheus exported, lua applet...).
24164
24165 LH The response was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
24166 it means a redirect was returned or an HTTP return statement was
24167 processed.
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020024168
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024169 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024170 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
24171 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024172 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024173 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
24174 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
24175
24176 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
24177 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
24178 503 or 504 here.
24179
24180 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024181 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024182 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
24183 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
24184 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
24185
24186 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
24187 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024188 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024189 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024190 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024191
24192 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
24193 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
24194 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
24195 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
24196 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
24197 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024198 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024199
24200 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
24201 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
24202 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
24203 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
24204 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
24205 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
24206 solution is to fix the application.
24207
24208 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
24209 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
24210 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
24211 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
24212 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
24213 external attacks.
24214
24215 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070024216 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020024217 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024218 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
24219 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
24220
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024221 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
24222 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
24223 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024224 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020024225 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024226
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024227 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
24228 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
24229 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
24230 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024231 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
24232 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
24233 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
24234 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020024235 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
24236 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
24237 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
24238 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024239
24240 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
24241 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
24242 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020024243 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
24244 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
24245 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
24246 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024247
24248 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
24249 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
24250 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
24251 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
24252
24253 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
24254 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
24255 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
24256 only be solved by proper system tuning.
24257
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024258The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024259persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024260important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
24261re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
24262
24263 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
24264
24265 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24266 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
24267 set on a GET request.
24268
24269 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
24270 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040024271 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024272 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
24273
24274 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
24275 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
24276 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
24277
24278 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24279 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
24280 already got a cookie.
24281
24282 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24283 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
24284 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
24285 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
24286 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
24287
24288 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24289 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24290 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24291
24292 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
24293 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24294 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24295
24296 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
24297 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
24298
24299 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
24300 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
24301 then advertised in the response.
24302
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200243048.6. Non-printable characters
24305-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024306
24307In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
24308consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
24309converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
24310prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
24311being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
24312escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
24313is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
24314'}' when logging headers.
24315
24316Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
24317issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
24318containing spaces is "User-Agent".
24319
24320Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
24321the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
24322performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
24323
24324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200243258.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
24326---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024327
24328Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
24329achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024330section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024331cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
24332the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
24333the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024334locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024335not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
24336user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
24337a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
24338wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
24339
24340 Examples :
24341 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
24342 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
24343
24344 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
24345 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
24346
24347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200243488.8. Capturing HTTP headers
24349---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024350
24351Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
24352proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
24353the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
24354server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
24355
24356Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
24357response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024358section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024359
24360It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024361time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
24362appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024363are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
24364and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
24365follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
24366request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
24367in the logs.
24368
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020024369As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
24370frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
24371an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
24372
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024373 Example :
24374 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
24375 listen proxy-out
24376 mode http
24377 option httplog
24378 option logasap
24379 log global
24380 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
24381
24382 # log the name of the virtual server
24383 capture request header Host len 20
24384
24385 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
24386 capture request header Content-Length len 10
24387
24388 # log the beginning of the referrer
24389 capture request header Referer len 20
24390
24391 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
24392 capture response header Server len 20
24393
24394 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
24395 capture response header Content-Length len 10
24396
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024397 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024398 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
24399
24400 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
24401 capture response header Via len 20
24402
24403 # log the URL location during a redirection
24404 capture response header Location len 20
24405
24406 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
24407 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
24408 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24409 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
24410 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
24411
24412 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24413 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24414 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24415 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024416 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024417
24418 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24419 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24420 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24421 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
24422 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024423 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024424
24425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200244268.9. Examples of logs
24427---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024428
24429These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
24430them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
24431reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
24432
24433 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
24434 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24435 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24436
24437 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
24438 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
24439
24440 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
24441 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
24442 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24443
24444 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
24445 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
24446
24447 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
24448 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24449 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
24450
24451 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024452 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024453 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
24454 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
24455
24456 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
24457 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
24458 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
24459
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024460 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
24461 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
24462 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
24463 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024464 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024465 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024466
24467 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024468 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024469
24470 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
24471 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
24472 Nothing was sent to any server.
24473
24474 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
24475 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
24476
24477 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
24478 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024479 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024480 send a 408 return code to the client.
24481
24482 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
24483 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
24484
24485 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
24486 5 seconds ("c----").
24487
24488 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
24489 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024490 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024491
24492 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024493 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024494 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
24495 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
24496 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
24497 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
24498 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010024499
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020024500
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200245019. Supported filters
24502--------------------
24503
24504Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
24505accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
24506unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
24507
24508See also : "filter"
24509
245109.1. Trace
24511----------
24512
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010024513filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024514
24515 Arguments:
24516 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
24517 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
24518
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010024519 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024520
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024521 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024522 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
24523 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
24524 amount of the parsed data.
24525
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024526 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010024527
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024528This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
24529callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
24530information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
24531filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
24532
24533Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
24534tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
24535a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
24536
24537
245389.2. HTTP compression
24539---------------------
24540
24541filter compression
24542
24543The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
24544keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024545when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
24546fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
24547done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
24548explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
24549filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
24550listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24551order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024552
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024553See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
24554 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024555
24556
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200245579.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
24558--------------------------------------------
24559
24560filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
24561
24562 Arguments :
24563
24564 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
24565 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
24566 parsed.
24567
24568 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
24569 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
24570 part must be placed in its own scope.
24571
24572The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
24573external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024574streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024575exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
24576also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
24577
24578SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
24579the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
24580
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010024581For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024582"doc/SPOE.txt".
24583
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100245849.4. Cache
24585----------
24586
24587filter cache <name>
24588
24589 Arguments :
24590
24591 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
24592
24593The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
24594"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050024595cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024596other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
24597case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
24598is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
24599filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010024600listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24601order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010024602
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024603See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
24604 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
24605
24606
246079.5. Fcgi-app
24608-------------
24609
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024610filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024611
24612 Arguments :
24613
24614 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
24615
24616The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
24617request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
24618reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
24619used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
24620implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
24621used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
24622fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
24623used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24624order.
24625
24626See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
24627 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
24628
24629
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100246309.6. OpenTracing
24631----------------
24632
24633The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
24634HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
24635of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
24636Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
24637
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024638This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024639
24640The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
24641HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
24642participates in the work of HAProxy.
24643
24644filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
24645
24646 Arguments :
24647
24648 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
24649 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
24650 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
24651 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
24652 OpenTracing filters.
24653
24654 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
24655 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
24656 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
24657 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
24658 filter must have its own scope defined.
24659
24660More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020024661of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024662
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200246639.7. Bandwidth limitation
24664--------------------------
24665
24666filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24667filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24668filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24669filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24670
24671 Arguments :
24672
24673 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
24674 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
24675
24676 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
24677 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24678 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24679 expressed in bytes.
24680
24681 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
24682 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
24683 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
24684 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24685
24686 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
24687 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
24688 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24689
24690 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024691 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024692 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
24693 is expressed in milliseconds.
24694
24695 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
24696 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
24697 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24698 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24699 expressed in bytes.
24700
24701Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
24702speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
24703bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
24704used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
24705sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
24706other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
24707connections for a given client.
24708
24709The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
24710filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
24711definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
24712the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
24713compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
24714the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
24715for the cache filter.
24716
24717There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
24718default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050024719to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024720the table.
24721
24722In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
24723limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
24724forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
24725the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
24726used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
24727cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
24728level.
24729
24730The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
24731connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
24732of the same connection may have different limits.
24733
24734For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
24735defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
24736bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
24737only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
24738when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
24739
24740For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
24741incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
24742corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24743stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24744used to limit outgoing data.
24745
24746Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
24747limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
24748to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
24749carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
24750it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
24751limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
24752experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
24753a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
24754start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
24755some experimentations.
24756
24757 Example:
24758 frontend http
24759 bind *:80
24760 mode http
24761
24762 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
24763 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
24764 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
24765
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024766 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024767 # independently of all other streams.
24768 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
24769
24770 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
24771 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
24772 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
24773 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
24774 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
24775 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
24776 ...
24777
24778 backend limit-by-src
24779 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
24780 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
24781
24782See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
24783 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
24784 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
24785 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024786
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002478710. FastCGI applications
24788-------------------------
24789
24790HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
24791feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
24792the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
24793FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
24794servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
24795FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
24796backend.
24797
24798HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
24799application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
24800connection.
24801
2480210.1. Setup
24803-----------
24804
2480510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
24806--------------------------
24807
24808fcgi-app <name>
24809 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
24810 document root must be defined.
24811
24812acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
24813 Declare or complete an access list.
24814
24815 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
24816 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
24817 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
24818 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
24819 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
24820
24821docroot <path>
24822 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
24823 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
24824 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
24825
24826index <script-name>
24827 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
24828 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
24829 is an optional setting.
24830
24831 Example :
24832 index index.php
24833
24834log-stderr global
24835log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010024836 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024837 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
24838
24839 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
24840 default STDERR messages are ignored.
24841
24842pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24843 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
24844 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
24845 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24846
24847 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
24848 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
24849 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
24850 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
24851
24852 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
24853 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
24854
24855path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024856 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024857 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
24858 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
24859 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
24860 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
24861 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
24862 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
24863 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024864
24865 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024866 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024867 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
24868 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
24869 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
24870 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024871
24872 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024873 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
24874 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024875
24876option get-values
24877no option get-values
24878 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
24879
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024880 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024881 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
24882
24883 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
24884 application will accept.
24885
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020024886 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
24887 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024888
24889 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050024890 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024891 option is disabled.
24892
24893 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
24894 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
24895 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
24896 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
24897 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
24898 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
24899
24900option keep-conn
24901no option keep-conn
24902 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
24903 sending a response.
24904
24905 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
24906 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
24907
24908option max-reqs <reqs>
24909 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
24910 accept.
24911
24912 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
24913 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
24914 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
24915 to 1.
24916
24917option mpxs-conns
24918no option mpxs-conns
24919 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
24920
24921 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
24922 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
24923
24924set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24925 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020024926 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.6
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024927 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
24928 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24929
24930 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
24931 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
24932 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
24933
24934 Example :
24935 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
24936 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
24937
24938 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
24939
24940
2494110.1.2. Proxy section
24942---------------------
24943
24944use-fcgi-app <name>
24945 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
24946
24947 Arguments :
24948 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
24949
24950 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
24951 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
24952 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
24953 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
24954 application may be defined at a time per backend.
24955
24956 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
24957 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
24958 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
24959 application are evaluated.
24960
24961
2496210.1.3. Example
24963---------------
24964
24965 frontend front-http
24966 mode http
24967 bind *:80
24968 bind *:
24969
24970 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
24971 default_backend back-static
24972
24973 backend back-static
24974 mode http
24975 server www A.B.C.D:80
24976
24977 backend back-dynamic
24978 mode http
24979 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
24980 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
24981
24982 fcgi-app php-fpm
24983 log-stderr global
24984 option keep-conn
24985
24986 docroot /var/www/my-app
24987 index index.php
24988 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
24989
24990
2499110.2. Default parameters
24992------------------------
24993
24994A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
24995the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024996script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024997applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
24998
24999 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25000 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
25001 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
25002 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
25003 | | |
25004 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25005 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
25006 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
25007 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
25008 | | application. |
25009 | | |
25010 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25011 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
25012 | | the request. It may not be set. |
25013 | | |
25014 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25015 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
25016 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
25017 | | the application's configuration. |
25018 | | |
25019 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25020 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
25021 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
25022 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
25023 | | |
25024 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25025 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
25026 | | following the part that identifies the script |
25027 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
25028 | | be defined. |
25029 | | |
25030 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25031 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
25032 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
25033 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
25034 | | is not set too. |
25035 | | |
25036 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25037 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
25038 | | set. |
25039 | | |
25040 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25041 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
25042 | | the request. |
25043 | | |
25044 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25045 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
25046 | | client as part of user authentication. |
25047 | | |
25048 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25049 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
25050 | | script to process the request. |
25051 | | |
25052 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25053 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
25054 | | |
25055 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25056 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
25057 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
25058 | | |
25059 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25060 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
25061 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
25062 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
25063 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
25064 | | |
25065 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25066 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
25067 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
25068 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
25069 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
25070 | | side. |
25071 | | |
25072 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25073 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
25074 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
25075 | | connected to. |
25076 | | |
25077 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25078 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
25079 | | |
25080 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020025081 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
25082 | | current HAProxy version. |
25083 | | |
25084 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020025085 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
25086 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
25087 | | |
25088 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25089
25090
2509110.3. Limitations
25092------------------
25093
25094The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
25095way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
25096during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
25097establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
25098application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
25099or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
25100message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
25101these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
25102and HTTP servers under the same backend.
25103
25104Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
25105request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
25106requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
25107
25108About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
25109into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
25110fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
25111"http-request" ones.
25112
25113Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
25114FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
25115processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
25116must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
25117here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010025118
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025119
2512011. Address formats
25121-------------------
25122
25123Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
25124address.
25125
25126This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
25127The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
25128of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
25129equivalent is '::'.
25130
25131Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
25132is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
25133
25134This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
25135family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
25136
25137Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
25138configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
25139use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
25140'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
25141
25142Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
25143socket type and the transport method.
25144
25145
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002514611.1. Address family prefixes
25147-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025148
25149'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
25150
25151'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
25152 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
25153 listening.
25154
25155'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
25156 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
25157 on the statement using this address, a port or
25158 a port range may or must be specified.
25159
25160'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25161 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
25162 using this address, a port or a port range
25163 may or must be specified.
25164
25165'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25166 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
25167 using this address, a port or a port range
25168 may or must be specified.
25169
25170'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
25171 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
25172 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
25173 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
25174 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
25175 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
25176
25177'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
25178 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
25179 start by slash '/'.
25180
25181
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002518211.2. Socket type prefixes
25183--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025184
25185Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
25186type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
25187this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
25188This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
25189but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
25190
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025191Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should instead use
25192use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes". However these can
25193sometimes be convenient, for example in combination with inherited sockets
25194known by their file descriptor number, in which case the address family is "fd"
25195and the socket type must be declared.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025196
25197If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
25198they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
25199report this to the maintainers.
25200
25201'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
25202 to "stream"
25203
25204'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
25205 to "datagram".
25206
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025207'quic+<family>@<address>' forces socket type to "datagram" and transport
25208 method to "stream".
25209
25210
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025211
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002521211.3. Protocol prefixes
25213-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025214
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025215'quic4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25216 an IPv4 address but socket type is forced to
25217 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
25218 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
25219 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025220 must be specified. It is equivalent to
25221 "quic+ipv4@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025222
25223'quic6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25224 an IPv6 address but socket type is forced to
25225 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
25226 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
25227 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025228 must be specified. It is equivalent to
25229 "quic+ipv6@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025230
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025231'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
25232 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
25233 socket type and transport method is forced to
25234 "stream". Depending on the statement using
25235 this address, a port or a port range can or
25236 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
25237 of 'stream+ip@'.
25238
25239'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25240 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
25241 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
25242 statement using this address, a port or port
25243 range can or must be specified.
25244 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
25245
25246'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25247 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
25248 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
25249 statement using this address, a port or port
25250 range can or must be specified.
25251 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
25252
25253'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
25254 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
25255 socket type and transport method is forced to
25256 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
25257 this address, a port or a port range can or
25258 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
25259 of 'dgram+ip@'.
25260
25261'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25262 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
25263 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25264 the statement using this address, a port or
25265 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025266 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025267
25268'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25269 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
25270 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25271 the statement using this address, a port or
25272 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025273 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025274
25275'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25276 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
25277 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
25278
25279'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25280 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
25281 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
25282
25283In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
25284QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
25285
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010025286/*
25287 * Local variables:
25288 * fill-column: 79
25289 * End:
25290 */